2015-06-03 17:28:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.\" $OpenBSD$
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.\"
|
2016-01-19 15:59:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.\" Copyright (c) 2007 Nicholas Marriott <nicholas.marriott@gmail.com>
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.\"
|
|
|
|
.\" Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any
|
|
|
|
.\" purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
|
|
|
|
.\" copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
|
|
|
|
.\"
|
|
|
|
.\" THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
|
|
|
|
.\" WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
|
|
|
|
.\" MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
|
|
|
|
.\" ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
|
|
|
|
.\" WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF MIND, USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER
|
|
|
|
.\" IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
|
|
|
|
.\" OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
|
|
|
|
.\"
|
2019-05-03 16:12:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Dd $Mdocdate$
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Dt TMUX 1
|
|
|
|
.Os
|
|
|
|
.Sh NAME
|
|
|
|
.Nm tmux
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nd terminal multiplexer
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh SYNOPSIS
|
|
|
|
.Nm tmux
|
|
|
|
.Bk -words
|
2015-06-07 22:42:25 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl 2CluvV
|
2009-09-23 15:18:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar shell-command
|
2008-06-06 15:23:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl f Ar file
|
2009-04-20 19:25:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl L Ar socket-name
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl S Ar socket-path
|
2008-06-06 15:23:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar command Op Ar flags
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ek
|
|
|
|
.Sh DESCRIPTION
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2009-08-09 16:54:46 +00:00
|
|
|
is a terminal multiplexer:
|
|
|
|
it enables a number of terminals to be created, accessed, and
|
|
|
|
controlled from a single screen.
|
2009-08-10 21:39:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
may be detached from a screen
|
|
|
|
and continue running in the background,
|
|
|
|
then later reattached.
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-09 16:59:35 +00:00
|
|
|
When
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
is started it creates a new
|
|
|
|
.Em session
|
|
|
|
with a single
|
|
|
|
.Em window
|
|
|
|
and displays it on screen.
|
|
|
|
A status line at the bottom of the screen
|
|
|
|
shows information on the current session
|
|
|
|
and is used to enter interactive commands.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
A session is a single collection of
|
|
|
|
.Em pseudo terminals
|
|
|
|
under the management of
|
|
|
|
.Nm .
|
|
|
|
Each session has one or more
|
|
|
|
windows linked to it.
|
|
|
|
A window occupies the entire screen
|
|
|
|
and may be split into rectangular panes,
|
|
|
|
each of which is a separate pseudo terminal
|
|
|
|
(the
|
2015-12-08 00:47:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr pty 4
|
2009-08-09 16:59:35 +00:00
|
|
|
manual page documents the technical details of pseudo terminals).
|
|
|
|
Any number of
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
instances may connect to the same session,
|
|
|
|
and any number of windows may be present in the same session.
|
|
|
|
Once all sessions are killed,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
exits.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
Each session is persistent and will survive accidental disconnection
|
2009-08-09 18:02:36 +00:00
|
|
|
(such as
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr ssh 1
|
2009-08-10 21:39:15 +00:00
|
|
|
connection timeout) or intentional detaching (with the
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql C-b d
|
|
|
|
key strokes).
|
2009-08-09 16:59:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
may be reattached using:
|
2009-08-09 16:59:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Dl $ tmux attach
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
In
|
|
|
|
.Nm ,
|
|
|
|
a session is displayed on screen by a
|
|
|
|
.Em client
|
|
|
|
and all sessions are managed by a single
|
|
|
|
.Em server .
|
|
|
|
The server and each client are separate processes which communicate through a
|
|
|
|
socket in
|
|
|
|
.Pa /tmp .
|
2009-08-09 18:02:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
The options are as follows:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width "XXXXXXXXXXXX"
|
2008-11-16 13:28:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl 2
|
|
|
|
Force
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
to assume the terminal supports 256 colours.
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl C
|
2013-08-21 23:32:55 +00:00
|
|
|
Start in control mode (see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx CONTROL MODE
|
|
|
|
section).
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
Given twice
|
|
|
|
.Xo ( Fl CC ) Xc
|
|
|
|
disables echo.
|
2009-09-23 15:18:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl c Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
Execute
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
using the default shell.
|
|
|
|
If necessary, the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
server will be started to retrieve the
|
|
|
|
.Ic default-shell
|
|
|
|
option.
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
This option is for compatibility with
|
|
|
|
.Xr sh 1
|
|
|
|
when
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
is used as a login shell.
|
2008-06-06 15:23:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl f Ar file
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
Specify an alternative configuration file.
|
|
|
|
By default,
|
2008-06-06 15:23:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2009-07-14 06:38:14 +00:00
|
|
|
loads the system configuration file from
|
2013-04-24 09:57:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pa @SYSCONFDIR@/tmux.conf ,
|
2009-07-14 06:38:14 +00:00
|
|
|
if present, then looks for a user configuration file at
|
2008-06-16 17:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pa ~/.tmux.conf .
|
2012-11-19 10:50:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2008-06-16 17:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
The configuration file is a set of
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
commands which are executed in sequence when the server is first started.
|
2012-11-19 10:50:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
loads configuration files once when the server process has started.
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ic source-file
|
|
|
|
command may be used to load a file later.
|
2009-08-09 17:19:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2012-11-19 10:50:24 +00:00
|
|
|
shows any error messages from commands in configuration files in the first
|
|
|
|
session created, and continues to process the rest of the configuration file.
|
2009-04-20 19:25:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl L Ar socket-name
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
stores the server socket in a directory under
|
2015-10-27 14:51:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ev TMUX_TMPDIR
|
|
|
|
or
|
2013-03-27 11:24:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pa /tmp
|
2015-10-27 14:51:35 +00:00
|
|
|
if it is unset.
|
2013-03-27 11:24:18 +00:00
|
|
|
The default socket is named
|
2009-04-20 19:25:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em default .
|
|
|
|
This option allows a different socket name to be specified, allowing several
|
|
|
|
independent
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
servers to be run.
|
|
|
|
Unlike
|
|
|
|
.Fl S
|
|
|
|
a full path is not necessary: the sockets are all created in the same
|
|
|
|
directory.
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If the socket is accidentally removed, the
|
|
|
|
.Dv SIGUSR1
|
|
|
|
signal may be sent to the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2015-04-21 22:32:40 +00:00
|
|
|
server process to recreate it (note that this will fail if any parent
|
|
|
|
directories are missing).
|
2010-05-14 14:19:41 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl l
|
|
|
|
Behave as a login shell.
|
|
|
|
This flag currently has no effect and is for compatibility with other shells
|
|
|
|
when using tmux as a login shell.
|
2008-06-06 15:23:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl S Ar socket-path
|
2009-04-20 19:25:58 +00:00
|
|
|
Specify a full alternative path to the server socket.
|
2009-05-04 17:58:27 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
2009-04-20 19:25:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl S
|
|
|
|
is specified, the default socket directory is not used and any
|
|
|
|
.Fl L
|
|
|
|
flag is ignored.
|
2008-11-17 17:41:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl u
|
2019-05-07 14:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
Write UTF-8 output to the terminal even if the first environment
|
|
|
|
variable of
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ev LC_ALL ,
|
2019-05-07 14:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ev LC_CTYPE ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ev LANG
|
2019-05-07 14:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
that is set does not contain
|
|
|
|
.Qq UTF-8
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Qq UTF8 .
|
2008-06-16 17:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl v
|
|
|
|
Request verbose logging.
|
|
|
|
Log messages will be saved into
|
|
|
|
.Pa tmux-client-PID.log
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Pa tmux-server-PID.log
|
|
|
|
files in the current directory, where
|
|
|
|
.Em PID
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
is the PID of the server or client process.
|
2017-06-04 08:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl v
|
|
|
|
is specified twice, an additional
|
|
|
|
.Pa tmux-out-PID.log
|
|
|
|
file is generated with a copy of everything
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
writes to the terminal.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Dv SIGUSR2
|
|
|
|
signal may be sent to the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
server process to toggle logging between on (as if
|
|
|
|
.Fl v
|
|
|
|
was given) and off.
|
2017-08-30 08:33:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Fl V
|
|
|
|
Report the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
version.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2008-06-06 15:23:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ar command Op Ar flags
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
This specifies one of a set of commands used to control
|
|
|
|
.Nm ,
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
as described in the following sections.
|
2009-08-09 16:54:46 +00:00
|
|
|
If no commands are specified, the
|
2008-06-03 05:35:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic new-session
|
|
|
|
command is assumed.
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2019-03-19 13:35:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh DEFAULT KEY BINDINGS
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
may be controlled from an attached client by using a key combination of a
|
|
|
|
prefix key,
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b
|
|
|
|
(Ctrl-b) by default, followed by a command key.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-06-06 00:21:36 +00:00
|
|
|
The default command key bindings are:
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width "XXXXXXXXXX" -offset indent -compact
|
|
|
|
.It C-b
|
|
|
|
Send the prefix key (C-b) through to the application.
|
|
|
|
.It C-o
|
|
|
|
Rotate the panes in the current window forwards.
|
|
|
|
.It C-z
|
|
|
|
Suspend the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
client.
|
|
|
|
.It !
|
|
|
|
Break the current pane out of the window.
|
|
|
|
.It \&"
|
2019-03-18 20:53:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.\" "
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
Split the current pane into two, top and bottom.
|
|
|
|
.It #
|
|
|
|
List all paste buffers.
|
2011-07-04 08:22:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.It $
|
|
|
|
Rename the current session.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It %
|
|
|
|
Split the current pane into two, left and right.
|
|
|
|
.It &
|
|
|
|
Kill the current window.
|
|
|
|
.It '
|
|
|
|
Prompt for a window index to select.
|
2015-01-06 09:12:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.It \&(
|
|
|
|
Switch the attached client to the previous session.
|
|
|
|
.It \&)
|
|
|
|
Switch the attached client to the next session.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It ,
|
|
|
|
Rename the current window.
|
|
|
|
.It -
|
|
|
|
Delete the most recently copied buffer of text.
|
|
|
|
.It .
|
|
|
|
Prompt for an index to move the current window.
|
|
|
|
.It 0 to 9
|
|
|
|
Select windows 0 to 9.
|
|
|
|
.It :
|
|
|
|
Enter the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
command prompt.
|
2010-10-24 01:34:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It ;
|
|
|
|
Move to the previously active pane.
|
2010-06-22 23:35:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.It =
|
|
|
|
Choose which buffer to paste interactively from a list.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It \&?
|
|
|
|
List all key bindings.
|
|
|
|
.It D
|
|
|
|
Choose a client to detach.
|
2015-01-06 09:12:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.It L
|
|
|
|
Switch the attached client back to the last session.
|
2010-07-17 14:39:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.It \&[
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
Enter copy mode to copy text or view the history.
|
2010-07-17 14:39:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.It \&]
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
Paste the most recently copied buffer of text.
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It c
|
2009-08-09 18:02:02 +00:00
|
|
|
Create a new window.
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It d
|
2009-08-09 18:02:02 +00:00
|
|
|
Detach the current client.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It f
|
|
|
|
Prompt to search for text in open windows.
|
|
|
|
.It i
|
|
|
|
Display some information about the current window.
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It l
|
2009-08-09 18:02:02 +00:00
|
|
|
Move to the previously selected window.
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It n
|
2009-08-09 18:02:02 +00:00
|
|
|
Change to the next window.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It o
|
|
|
|
Select the next pane in the current window.
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It p
|
2009-08-09 18:02:02 +00:00
|
|
|
Change to the previous window.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It q
|
|
|
|
Briefly display pane indexes.
|
|
|
|
.It r
|
|
|
|
Force redraw of the attached client.
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.It m
|
|
|
|
Mark the current pane (see
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-pane
|
|
|
|
.Fl m ) .
|
|
|
|
.It M
|
|
|
|
Clear the marked pane.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It s
|
|
|
|
Select a new session for the attached client interactively.
|
|
|
|
.It t
|
|
|
|
Show the time.
|
|
|
|
.It w
|
|
|
|
Choose the current window interactively.
|
|
|
|
.It x
|
|
|
|
Kill the current pane.
|
2015-01-06 09:12:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.It z
|
|
|
|
Toggle zoom state of the current pane.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It {
|
|
|
|
Swap the current pane with the previous pane.
|
|
|
|
.It }
|
|
|
|
Swap the current pane with the next pane.
|
|
|
|
.It ~
|
|
|
|
Show previous messages from
|
|
|
|
.Nm ,
|
|
|
|
if any.
|
|
|
|
.It Page Up
|
|
|
|
Enter copy mode and scroll one page up.
|
|
|
|
.It Up, Down
|
|
|
|
.It Left, Right
|
|
|
|
Change to the pane above, below, to the left, or to the right of the current
|
|
|
|
pane.
|
|
|
|
.It M-1 to M-5
|
|
|
|
Arrange panes in one of the five preset layouts: even-horizontal,
|
|
|
|
even-vertical, main-horizontal, main-vertical, or tiled.
|
2015-01-06 09:12:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Space
|
|
|
|
Arrange the current window in the next preset layout.
|
2010-06-06 00:20:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It M-n
|
|
|
|
Move to the next window with a bell or activity marker.
|
|
|
|
.It M-o
|
|
|
|
Rotate the panes in the current window backwards.
|
|
|
|
.It M-p
|
|
|
|
Move to the previous window with a bell or activity marker.
|
|
|
|
.It C-Up, C-Down
|
|
|
|
.It C-Left, C-Right
|
|
|
|
Resize the current pane in steps of one cell.
|
|
|
|
.It M-Up, M-Down
|
|
|
|
.It M-Left, M-Right
|
|
|
|
Resize the current pane in steps of five cells.
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Key bindings may be changed with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic bind-key
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic unbind-key
|
|
|
|
commands.
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh COMMAND PARSING AND EXECUTION
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
supports a large number of commands which can be used to control its
|
|
|
|
behaviour.
|
|
|
|
Each command is named and can accept zero or more flags and arguments.
|
|
|
|
They may be bound to a key with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic bind-key
|
|
|
|
command or run from the shell prompt, a shell script, a configuration file or
|
|
|
|
the command prompt.
|
|
|
|
For example, the same
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-option
|
|
|
|
command run from the shell prompt, from
|
|
|
|
.Pa ~/.tmux.conf
|
|
|
|
and bound to a key may look like:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ tmux set-option -g status-style bg=cyan
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
set-option -g status-style bg=cyan
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bind-key C set-option -g status-style bg=cyan
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Here, the command name is
|
|
|
|
.Ql set-option ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql Fl g
|
|
|
|
is a flag and
|
|
|
|
.Ql status-style
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql bg=cyan
|
|
|
|
are arguments.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
distinguishes between command parsing and execution.
|
|
|
|
In order to execute a command,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
needs it to be split up into its name and arguments.
|
|
|
|
This is command parsing.
|
|
|
|
If a command is run from the shell, the shell parses it; from inside
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
or from a configuration file,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
does.
|
|
|
|
Examples of when
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
parses commands are:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -dash -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
in a configuration file;
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
typed at the command prompt (see
|
|
|
|
.Ic command-prompt ) ;
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
given to
|
|
|
|
.Ic bind-key ;
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
passed as arguments to
|
|
|
|
.Ic if-shell
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic confirm-before .
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
To execute commands, each client has a
|
|
|
|
.Ql command queue .
|
|
|
|
A global command queue not attached to any client is used on startup
|
|
|
|
for configuration files like
|
|
|
|
.Pa ~/.tmux.conf .
|
|
|
|
Parsed commands added to the queue are executed in order.
|
|
|
|
Some commands, like
|
|
|
|
.Ic if-shell
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic confirm-before ,
|
|
|
|
parse their argument to create a new command which is inserted immediately
|
|
|
|
after themselves.
|
|
|
|
This means that arguments can be parsed twice or more - once when the parent command (such as
|
|
|
|
.Ic if-shell )
|
|
|
|
is parsed and again when it parses and executes its command.
|
|
|
|
Commands like
|
|
|
|
.Ic if-shell ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic run-shell
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes
|
|
|
|
stop execution of subsequent commands on the queue until something happens -
|
|
|
|
.Ic if-shell
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic run-shell
|
|
|
|
until a shell command finishes and
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes
|
|
|
|
until a key is pressed.
|
|
|
|
For example, the following commands:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
new-session; new-window
|
|
|
|
if-shell "true" "split-window"
|
|
|
|
kill-session
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Will execute
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-session ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-window ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic if-shell ,
|
|
|
|
the shell command
|
|
|
|
.Xr true 1 ,
|
2019-06-21 07:11:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic split-window
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic kill-session
|
|
|
|
in that order.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Sx COMMANDS
|
|
|
|
section lists the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
commands and their arguments.
|
|
|
|
.Sh PARSING SYNTAX
|
|
|
|
This section describes the syntax of commands parsed by
|
|
|
|
.Nm ,
|
|
|
|
for example in a configuration file or at the command prompt.
|
2019-06-21 07:11:01 +00:00
|
|
|
Note that when commands are entered into the shell, they are parsed by the shell
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
- see for example
|
|
|
|
.Xr ksh 1
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Xr csh 1 .
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Each command is terminated by a newline or a semicolon (;).
|
|
|
|
Commands separated by semicolons together form a
|
|
|
|
.Ql command sequence
|
|
|
|
- if a command in the sequence encounters an error, no subsequent commands are
|
|
|
|
executed.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Comments are marked by the unquoted # character - any remaining text after a
|
|
|
|
comment is ignored until the end of the line.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If the last character of a line is \e, the line is joined with the following
|
|
|
|
line (the \e and the newline are completely removed).
|
|
|
|
This is called line continuation and applies both inside and outside quoted
|
2019-05-27 16:22:32 +00:00
|
|
|
strings and in comments, but not inside braces.
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-05-27 12:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
Command arguments may be specified as strings surrounded by single (') quotes,
|
|
|
|
double quotes (") or braces ({}).
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.\" "
|
|
|
|
This is required when the argument contains any special character.
|
2019-05-27 12:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
Single and double quoted strings cannot span multiple lines except with line
|
|
|
|
continuation.
|
|
|
|
Braces can span multiple lines.
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Outside of quotes and inside double quotes, these replacements are performed:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -dash -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
Environment variables preceded by $ are replaced with their value from the
|
|
|
|
global environment (see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx GLOBAL AND SESSION ENVIRONMENT
|
|
|
|
section).
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
A leading ~ or ~user is expanded to the home directory of the current or
|
|
|
|
specified user.
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
\euXXXX or \euXXXXXXXX is replaced by the Unicode codepoint corresponding to
|
|
|
|
the given four or eight digit hexadecimal number.
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
When preceded (escaped) by a \e, the following characters are replaced: \ee by
|
|
|
|
the escape character; \er by a carriage return; \en by a newline; and \et by a
|
|
|
|
tab.
|
2019-05-29 10:08:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
\eooo is replaced by a character of the octal value ooo.
|
|
|
|
Three octal digits are required, for example \e001.
|
|
|
|
The largest valid character is \e377.
|
|
|
|
.It
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
Any other characters preceded by \e are replaced by themselves (that is, the \e
|
|
|
|
is removed) and are not treated as having any special meaning - so for example
|
|
|
|
\e; will not mark a command sequence and \e$ will not expand an environment
|
|
|
|
variable.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-05-27 12:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
Braces are similar to single quotes in that the text inside is taken literally
|
2019-05-27 16:22:32 +00:00
|
|
|
without any replacements but this also includes line continuation.
|
|
|
|
Braces can span multiple lines in which case a literal newline is included in the
|
|
|
|
string.
|
2019-05-27 12:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
They are designed to avoid the need for additional escaping when passing a group
|
|
|
|
of
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
or shell commands as an argument (for example to
|
|
|
|
.Ic if-shell
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic pipe-pane ) .
|
|
|
|
These two examples produce an identical command - note that no escaping is
|
|
|
|
needed when using {}:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
if-shell true {
|
|
|
|
display -p 'brace-dollar-foo: }$foo'
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if-shell true "\en display -p 'brace-dollar-foo: }\e$foo'\en"
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Braces may be enclosed inside braces, for example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
bind x if-shell "true" {
|
|
|
|
if-shell "true" {
|
|
|
|
display "true!"
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
Environment variables may be set by using the syntax
|
|
|
|
.Ql name=value ,
|
|
|
|
for example
|
|
|
|
.Ql HOME=/home/user .
|
|
|
|
Variables set during parsing are added to the global environment.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Commands may be parsed conditionally by surrounding them with
|
|
|
|
.Ql %if ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql %elif ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql %else
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql %endif .
|
|
|
|
The argument to
|
|
|
|
.Ql %if
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql %elif
|
|
|
|
is expanded as a format (see
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS )
|
|
|
|
and if it evaluates to false (zero or empty), subsequent text is ignored until
|
|
|
|
the closing
|
|
|
|
.Ql %elif ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql %else
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql %endif .
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2019-06-14 12:04:11 +00:00
|
|
|
%if "#{==:#{host},myhost}"
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
set -g status-style bg=red
|
2019-06-14 12:04:11 +00:00
|
|
|
%elif "#{==:#{host},myotherhost}"
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
set -g status-style bg=green
|
|
|
|
%else
|
|
|
|
set -g status-style bg=blue
|
|
|
|
%endif
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Will change the status line to red if running on
|
|
|
|
.Ql myhost ,
|
|
|
|
green if running on
|
|
|
|
.Ql myotherhost ,
|
|
|
|
or blue if running on another host.
|
|
|
|
Conditionals may be given on one line, for example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
%if #{==:#{host},myhost} set -g status-style bg=red %endif
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh COMMANDS
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
This section describes the commands supported by
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm .
|
|
|
|
Most commands accept the optional
|
|
|
|
.Fl t
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
(and sometimes
|
|
|
|
.Fl s )
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
argument with one of
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-client ,
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-window ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane .
|
|
|
|
These specify the client, session, window or pane which a command should affect.
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-client
|
2017-04-05 10:49:46 +00:00
|
|
|
should be the name of the client,
|
|
|
|
typically the
|
2015-12-08 00:48:22 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr pty 4
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
file to which the client is connected, for example either of
|
|
|
|
.Pa /dev/ttyp1
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Pa ttyp1
|
|
|
|
for the client attached to
|
|
|
|
.Pa /dev/ttyp1 .
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
If no client is specified,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
attempts to work out the client currently in use; if that fails, an error is
|
|
|
|
reported.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Clients may be listed with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-clients
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2007-12-16 17:18:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-session
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
is tried as, in order:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -enum -offset Ds
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
A session ID prefixed with a $.
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
An exact name of a session (as listed by the
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic list-sessions
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
command).
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
The start of a session name, for example
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysess
|
|
|
|
would match a session named
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysession .
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
An
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr fnmatch 3
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
pattern which is matched against the session name.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-06-18 23:53:56 +00:00
|
|
|
If the session name is prefixed with an
|
|
|
|
.Ql = ,
|
2015-06-05 08:14:16 +00:00
|
|
|
only an exact match is accepted (so
|
|
|
|
.Ql =mysess
|
|
|
|
will only match exactly
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysess ,
|
|
|
|
not
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysession ) .
|
2015-06-18 23:53:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
If a single session is found, it is used as the target session; multiple matches
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
produce an error.
|
|
|
|
If a session is omitted, the current session is used if available; if no
|
2009-11-04 22:46:25 +00:00
|
|
|
current session is available, the most recently used is chosen.
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-window
|
2015-12-11 16:27:01 +00:00
|
|
|
(or
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-window
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-window )
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
specifies a window in the form
|
|
|
|
.Em session Ns \&: Ns Em window .
|
|
|
|
.Em session
|
|
|
|
follows the same rules as for
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session ,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Em window
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
is looked for in order as:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -enum -offset Ds
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
A special token, listed below.
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
A window index, for example
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysession:1
|
|
|
|
is window 1 in session
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysession .
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
A window ID, such as @1.
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
An exact window name, such as
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysession:mywindow .
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
The start of a window name, such as
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysession:mywin .
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
As an
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr fnmatch 3
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
pattern matched against the window name.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-06-05 08:14:16 +00:00
|
|
|
Like sessions, a
|
|
|
|
.Ql =
|
|
|
|
prefix will do an exact match only.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
An empty window name specifies the next unused index if appropriate (for
|
|
|
|
example the
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic link-window
|
|
|
|
commands)
|
|
|
|
otherwise the current window in
|
|
|
|
.Em session
|
|
|
|
is chosen.
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-04-28 10:43:13 +00:00
|
|
|
The following special tokens are available to indicate particular windows.
|
|
|
|
Each has a single-character alternative form.
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -column "XXXXXXXXXX" "X"
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Token" Ta Sy "" Ta Sy "Meaning"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{start}" Ta "^" Ta "The lowest-numbered window"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{end}" Ta "$" Ta "The highest-numbered window"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{last}" Ta "!" Ta "The last (previously current) window"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{next}" Ta "+" Ta "The next window by number"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{previous}" Ta "-" Ta "The previous window by number"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane
|
2015-12-11 16:27:01 +00:00
|
|
|
(or
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-pane )
|
|
|
|
may be a pane ID or takes a similar form to
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-window
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
but with the optional addition of a period followed by a pane index or pane ID,
|
|
|
|
for example:
|
|
|
|
.Ql mysession:mywindow.1 .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
If the pane index is omitted, the currently active pane in the specified
|
|
|
|
window is used.
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
The following special tokens are available for the pane index:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "XXXXXXXXXXXXXX" "X"
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Token" Ta Sy "" Ta Sy "Meaning"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{last}" Ta "!" Ta "The last (previously active) pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{next}" Ta "+" Ta "The next pane by number"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{previous}" Ta "-" Ta "The previous pane by number"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{top}" Ta "" Ta "The top pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{bottom}" Ta "" Ta "The bottom pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{left}" Ta "" Ta "The leftmost pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{right}" Ta "" Ta "The rightmost pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{top-left}" Ta "" Ta "The top-left pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{top-right}" Ta "" Ta "The top-right pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{bottom-left}" Ta "" Ta "The bottom-left pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{bottom-right}" Ta "" Ta "The bottom-right pane"
|
2015-08-12 08:55:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "{up-of}" Ta "" Ta "The pane above the active pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{down-of}" Ta "" Ta "The pane below the active pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{left-of}" Ta "" Ta "The pane to the left of the active pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "{right-of}" Ta "" Ta "The pane to the right of the active pane"
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
The tokens
|
2010-06-22 23:29:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql +
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql -
|
|
|
|
may be followed by an offset, for example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
select-window -t:+2
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
In addition,
|
|
|
|
.Em target-session ,
|
|
|
|
.Em target-window
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Em target-pane
|
|
|
|
may consist entirely of the token
|
|
|
|
.Ql {mouse}
|
|
|
|
(alternative form
|
|
|
|
.Ql = )
|
|
|
|
to specify the most recent mouse event
|
|
|
|
(see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx MOUSE SUPPORT
|
|
|
|
section)
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql {marked}
|
|
|
|
(alternative form
|
|
|
|
.Ql ~ )
|
|
|
|
to specify the marked pane (see
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-pane
|
|
|
|
.Fl m ) .
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
Sessions, window and panes are each numbered with a unique ID; session IDs are
|
|
|
|
prefixed with a
|
|
|
|
.Ql $ ,
|
|
|
|
windows with a
|
|
|
|
.Ql @ ,
|
|
|
|
and panes with a
|
|
|
|
.Ql % .
|
|
|
|
These are unique and are unchanged for the life of the session, window or pane
|
|
|
|
in the
|
2011-04-06 22:16:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
server.
|
|
|
|
The pane ID is passed to the child process of the pane in the
|
2011-04-06 22:16:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ev TMUX_PANE
|
|
|
|
environment variable.
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
IDs may be displayed using the
|
|
|
|
.Ql session_id ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql window_id ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql pane_id
|
|
|
|
formats (see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section) and the
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-message ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-sessions ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-windows
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-panes
|
|
|
|
commands.
|
2011-04-06 22:16:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
arguments are
|
|
|
|
.Xr sh 1
|
|
|
|
commands.
|
2014-05-13 08:08:32 +00:00
|
|
|
This may be a single argument passed to the shell, for example:
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
new-window 'vi /etc/passwd'
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-05-13 08:08:32 +00:00
|
|
|
Will run:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
/bin/sh -c 'vi /etc/passwd'
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Additionally, the
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-window ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-session ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic split-window ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic respawn-window
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic respawn-pane
|
|
|
|
commands allow
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
to be given as multiple arguments and executed directly (without
|
|
|
|
.Ql sh -c ) .
|
|
|
|
This can avoid issues with shell quoting.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ tmux new-window vi /etc/passwd
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Will run
|
|
|
|
.Xr vi 1
|
|
|
|
directly without invoking the shell.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar command
|
|
|
|
.Op Ar arguments
|
|
|
|
refers to a
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2019-05-27 12:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
command, either passed with the command and arguments separately, for example:
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
bind-key F1 set-option status off
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-05-27 12:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
Or passed as a single string argument in
|
|
|
|
.Pa .tmux.conf ,
|
|
|
|
for example:
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2019-05-27 12:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
bind-key F1 { set-option status off }
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Example
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
commands include:
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
refresh-client -t/dev/ttyp2
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
rename-session -tfirst newname
|
|
|
|
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
set-option -wt:0 monitor-activity on
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
new-window ; split-window -d
|
2011-08-25 21:14:23 +00:00
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bind-key R source-file ~/.tmux.conf \e; \e
|
|
|
|
display-message "source-file done"
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Or from
|
|
|
|
.Xr sh 1 :
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ tmux kill-window -t :1
|
|
|
|
|
2010-03-27 15:12:11 +00:00
|
|
|
$ tmux new-window \e; split-window -d
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
|
2010-03-27 15:12:11 +00:00
|
|
|
$ tmux new-session -d 'vi /etc/passwd' \e; split-window -d \e; attach
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh CLIENTS AND SESSIONS
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
server manages clients, sessions, windows and panes.
|
|
|
|
Clients are attached to sessions to interact with them, either
|
|
|
|
when they are created with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-session
|
|
|
|
command, or later with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic attach-session
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2010-12-06 21:49:57 +00:00
|
|
|
Each session has one or more windows
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em linked
|
|
|
|
into it.
|
|
|
|
Windows may be linked to multiple sessions and are made up of one or
|
|
|
|
more panes,
|
|
|
|
each of which contains a pseudo terminal.
|
|
|
|
Commands for creating, linking and otherwise manipulating windows
|
|
|
|
are covered
|
|
|
|
in the
|
|
|
|
.Sx WINDOWS AND PANES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The following commands are available to manage clients and sessions:
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic attach-session
|
2019-06-03 18:28:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl dErx
|
2013-10-06 20:02:23 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar working-directory
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic attach )
|
|
|
|
If run from outside
|
|
|
|
.Nm ,
|
|
|
|
create a new client in the current terminal and attach it to
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session .
|
|
|
|
If used from inside, switch the current client.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
is specified, any other clients attached to the session are detached.
|
2019-06-03 18:28:37 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl x
|
|
|
|
is given, send SIGHUP to the parent process of the client as well as
|
|
|
|
detaching the client, typically causing it to exit.
|
2010-02-08 18:27:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl r
|
|
|
|
signifies the client is read-only (only keys bound to the
|
|
|
|
.Ic detach-client
|
2011-08-21 12:38:55 +00:00
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic switch-client
|
|
|
|
commands have any effect)
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
If no server is started,
|
|
|
|
.Ic attach-session
|
|
|
|
will attempt to start it; this will fail unless sessions are created in the
|
|
|
|
configuration file.
|
2011-04-06 22:24:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
rules for
|
|
|
|
.Ic attach-session
|
|
|
|
are slightly adjusted: if
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
needs to select the most recently used session, it will prefer the most
|
|
|
|
recently used
|
|
|
|
.Em unattached
|
|
|
|
session.
|
2013-10-06 20:02:23 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl c
|
|
|
|
will set the session working directory (used for new windows) to
|
|
|
|
.Ar working-directory .
|
2015-06-07 21:39:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl E
|
2016-03-01 11:58:45 +00:00
|
|
|
is used, the
|
2015-06-07 21:39:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic update-environment
|
|
|
|
option will not be applied.
|
2011-03-19 23:27:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic detach-client
|
2015-11-24 20:40:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl aP
|
2017-01-13 10:12:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl E Ar shell-command
|
2011-04-11 06:44:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar target-session
|
2011-04-18 21:05:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
2011-03-19 23:27:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic detach )
|
2011-04-11 06:44:56 +00:00
|
|
|
Detach the current client if bound to a key, the client specified with
|
|
|
|
.Fl t ,
|
2011-12-25 23:36:27 +00:00
|
|
|
or all clients currently attached to the session specified by
|
2011-04-11 06:44:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl s .
|
2012-06-18 15:11:35 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
option kills all but the client given with
|
|
|
|
.Fl t .
|
2011-03-19 23:27:35 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl P
|
|
|
|
is given, send SIGHUP to the parent process of the client, typically causing it
|
|
|
|
to exit.
|
2017-01-13 10:12:12 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl E ,
|
|
|
|
run
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
to replace the client.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic has-session Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic has )
|
|
|
|
Report an error and exit with 1 if the specified session does not exist.
|
|
|
|
If it does exist, exit with 0.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic kill-server
|
|
|
|
Kill the
|
2007-11-09 16:18:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
server and clients and destroy all sessions.
|
2013-08-21 23:32:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic kill-session
|
2015-11-24 21:52:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl aC
|
2012-06-18 15:12:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
2013-08-21 23:32:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Destroy the given session, closing any windows linked to it and no other
|
|
|
|
sessions, and detaching all clients attached to it.
|
2012-06-18 15:12:54 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
is given, all sessions but the specified one is killed.
|
2015-11-24 21:52:06 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl C
|
2015-11-24 23:46:15 +00:00
|
|
|
flag clears alerts (bell, activity, or silence) in all windows linked to the
|
2015-11-24 21:52:06 +00:00
|
|
|
session.
|
2011-10-23 15:03:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic list-clients
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lsc )
|
|
|
|
List all clients attached to the server.
|
2011-10-23 15:03:50 +00:00
|
|
|
For the meaning of the
|
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
flag, see the
|
2011-10-31 13:56:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2011-04-18 21:05:24 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
is specified, list only clients connected to that session.
|
2016-06-15 08:54:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic list-commands
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lscm )
|
|
|
|
List the syntax of all commands supported by
|
|
|
|
.Nm .
|
2011-10-02 11:31:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic list-sessions Op Fl F Ar format
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic ls )
|
|
|
|
List all sessions managed by the server.
|
2011-10-02 11:31:34 +00:00
|
|
|
For the meaning of the
|
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
flag, see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2010-06-06 00:31:32 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic lock-client Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lockc )
|
2009-09-25 17:51:39 +00:00
|
|
|
Lock
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-client ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic lock-server
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2010-06-06 00:31:32 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic lock-session Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic locks )
|
2009-09-25 17:51:39 +00:00
|
|
|
Lock all clients attached to
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic new-session
|
2019-06-03 18:28:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl AdDEPX
|
2013-10-01 22:48:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar start-directory
|
2013-03-22 17:01:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl n Ar window-name
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar session-name
|
2017-02-09 15:04:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar group-name
|
2011-01-21 23:55:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl x Ar width
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl y Ar height
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar shell-command
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic new )
|
|
|
|
Create a new session with name
|
|
|
|
.Ar session-name .
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
The new session is attached to the current terminal unless
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
is given.
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-name
|
2007-11-09 16:18:08 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
are the name of and shell command to execute in the initial window.
|
2017-05-29 07:46:32 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl d ,
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
the initial size comes from the global
|
2019-05-02 20:12:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic default-size
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
option;
|
2011-01-21 23:55:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl x
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl y
|
2017-05-29 07:46:32 +00:00
|
|
|
can be used to specify a different size.
|
2018-06-08 09:43:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql -
|
|
|
|
uses the size of the current client if any.
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl x
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Fl y
|
|
|
|
is given, the
|
2019-05-02 20:12:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic default-size
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
option is set for the session.
|
2009-08-16 18:59:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If run from a terminal, any
|
2015-12-08 00:49:10 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr termios 4
|
2009-08-16 18:59:12 +00:00
|
|
|
special characters are saved and used for new windows in the new session.
|
2009-10-11 23:38:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2013-02-24 00:43:28 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl A
|
|
|
|
flag makes
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-session
|
|
|
|
behave like
|
|
|
|
.Ic attach-session
|
|
|
|
if
|
|
|
|
.Ar session-name
|
2015-04-10 07:23:14 +00:00
|
|
|
already exists; in this case,
|
2013-02-24 00:43:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl D
|
|
|
|
behaves like
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
to
|
2019-06-03 18:28:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic attach-session ,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl X
|
|
|
|
behaves like
|
|
|
|
.Fl x
|
|
|
|
to
|
2013-02-24 00:43:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic attach-session .
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-10-11 23:38:16 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl t
|
2017-02-09 15:04:53 +00:00
|
|
|
is given, it specifies a
|
|
|
|
.Ic session group .
|
|
|
|
Sessions in the same group share the same set of windows - new windows are
|
2017-02-10 12:59:18 +00:00
|
|
|
linked to all sessions in the group and any windows closed removed from all
|
2017-02-09 15:04:53 +00:00
|
|
|
sessions.
|
2009-10-11 23:38:16 +00:00
|
|
|
The current and previous window and any session options remain independent and
|
2017-02-09 15:04:53 +00:00
|
|
|
any session in a group may be killed without affecting the others.
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ar group-name
|
|
|
|
argument may be:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -enum -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
the name of an existing group, in which case the new session is added to that
|
|
|
|
group;
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
the name of an existing session - the new session is added to the same group
|
|
|
|
as that session, creating a new group if necessary;
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
the name for a new group containing only the new session.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-10-11 23:38:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
2016-03-01 11:58:45 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
2009-10-11 23:38:16 +00:00
|
|
|
are invalid if
|
|
|
|
.Fl t
|
|
|
|
is used.
|
2013-03-22 17:01:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl P
|
|
|
|
option prints information about the new session after it has been created.
|
|
|
|
By default, it uses the format
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{session_name}:
|
|
|
|
but a different format may be specified with
|
|
|
|
.Fl F .
|
2015-06-07 21:39:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl E
|
2016-03-01 11:58:45 +00:00
|
|
|
is used, the
|
2015-06-07 21:39:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic update-environment
|
|
|
|
option will not be applied.
|
2011-10-02 11:33:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic refresh-client
|
2018-10-18 13:03:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl cDlLRSU
|
2017-02-09 14:49:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl C Ar width,height
|
2011-10-02 11:33:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
2018-08-21 08:27:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar adjustment
|
2011-10-02 11:33:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic refresh )
|
|
|
|
Refresh the current client if bound to a key, or a single client if one is given
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl t .
|
2011-10-02 11:33:14 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl S
|
2017-02-15 08:47:55 +00:00
|
|
|
is specified, only update the client's status line.
|
2017-02-09 14:49:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2018-08-21 08:27:19 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl U ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl D ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl L
|
|
|
|
.Fl R ,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl c
|
|
|
|
flags allow the visible portion of a window which is larger than the client
|
|
|
|
to be changed.
|
|
|
|
.Fl U
|
|
|
|
moves the visible part up by
|
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
rows and
|
|
|
|
.Fl D
|
|
|
|
down,
|
|
|
|
.Fl L
|
|
|
|
left by
|
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
columns and
|
|
|
|
.Fl R
|
|
|
|
right.
|
|
|
|
.Fl c
|
|
|
|
returns to tracking the cursor automatically.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
is omitted, 1 is used.
|
|
|
|
Note that the visible position is a property of the client not of the
|
|
|
|
window, changing the current window in the attached session will reset
|
|
|
|
it.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-02-09 14:49:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl C
|
|
|
|
sets the width and height of a control client.
|
2018-10-11 15:20:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl l
|
|
|
|
requests the clipboard from the client using the
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1
|
|
|
|
escape sequence and stores it in a new paste buffer.
|
2018-10-18 13:03:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl L ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl R ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl U
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl D
|
|
|
|
move the visible portion of the window left, right, up or down
|
|
|
|
by
|
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment ,
|
|
|
|
if the window is larger than the client.
|
|
|
|
.Fl c
|
|
|
|
resets so that the position follows the cursor.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Ic window-size
|
|
|
|
option.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic rename-session
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Ar new-name
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic rename )
|
|
|
|
Rename the session to
|
|
|
|
.Ar new-name .
|
2009-11-19 22:23:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic show-messages
|
2015-11-24 21:52:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl JT
|
2009-11-19 22:20:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic showmsgs )
|
2014-01-22 14:43:42 +00:00
|
|
|
Show client messages or server information.
|
2009-11-19 22:20:04 +00:00
|
|
|
Any messages displayed on the status line are saved in a per-client message
|
|
|
|
log, up to a maximum of the limit set by the
|
|
|
|
.Ar message-limit
|
2014-03-07 15:37:01 +00:00
|
|
|
server option.
|
2014-01-22 14:43:42 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl t ,
|
|
|
|
display the log for
|
2009-11-19 22:20:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-client .
|
2014-01-22 14:43:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl J
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
2015-11-24 21:52:06 +00:00
|
|
|
show debugging information about jobs and terminals.
|
2016-05-12 16:05:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic source-file
|
2019-06-05 20:00:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl nqv
|
2016-05-12 16:05:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar path
|
2019-05-28 11:46:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar ...
|
2016-05-12 16:05:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic source )
|
2019-05-28 11:46:30 +00:00
|
|
|
Execute commands from one or more files specified by
|
2017-01-09 19:27:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar path
|
2019-05-28 11:46:30 +00:00
|
|
|
(which may be
|
2018-07-23 19:02:49 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr glob 7
|
2019-05-28 11:46:30 +00:00
|
|
|
patterns).
|
2016-05-12 16:05:33 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl q
|
|
|
|
is given, no error will be returned if
|
|
|
|
.Ar path
|
|
|
|
does not exist.
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl n ,
|
|
|
|
the file is parsed but no commands are executed.
|
2019-06-05 20:00:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl v
|
|
|
|
shows the parsed commands and line numbers if possible.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic start-server
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic start )
|
|
|
|
Start the
|
2007-11-24 14:21:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
server, if not already running, without creating any sessions.
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic suspend-client
|
2011-01-03 23:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic suspendc )
|
|
|
|
Suspend a client by sending
|
|
|
|
.Dv SIGTSTP
|
|
|
|
(tty stop).
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic switch-client
|
2015-06-07 21:39:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl Elnpr
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl T Ar key-table
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic switchc )
|
|
|
|
Switch the current session for client
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session .
|
2019-04-08 08:36:34 +00:00
|
|
|
As a special case,
|
|
|
|
.Fl t
|
|
|
|
may refer to a pane (a target that contains
|
2019-05-03 16:12:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql \&: ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql \&.
|
2019-04-08 08:36:34 +00:00
|
|
|
or
|
2019-05-03 16:12:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql % ) ,
|
2019-04-08 08:36:34 +00:00
|
|
|
in which case the session, window and pane are all changed.
|
2010-09-10 13:36:17 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
2010-12-27 21:17:25 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl l ,
|
2010-09-10 13:36:17 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
2010-12-11 18:42:20 +00:00
|
|
|
is used, the client is moved to the last, next or previous session
|
|
|
|
respectively.
|
2011-08-21 12:38:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl r
|
|
|
|
toggles whether a client is read-only (see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic attach-session
|
|
|
|
command).
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-06-07 21:39:39 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl E
|
|
|
|
is used,
|
|
|
|
.Ic update-environment
|
|
|
|
option will not be applied.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
sets the client's key table; the next key from the client will be interpreted from
|
|
|
|
.Ar key-table .
|
|
|
|
This may be used to configure multiple prefix keys, or to bind commands to
|
|
|
|
sequences of keys.
|
|
|
|
For example, to make typing
|
|
|
|
.Ql abc
|
|
|
|
run the
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-keys
|
|
|
|
command:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
bind-key -Ttable2 c list-keys
|
|
|
|
bind-key -Ttable1 b switch-client -Ttable2
|
|
|
|
bind-key -Troot a switch-client -Ttable1
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Sh WINDOWS AND PANES
|
2007-11-24 14:21:43 +00:00
|
|
|
A
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2016-08-22 20:07:58 +00:00
|
|
|
window may be in one of two modes.
|
2007-11-24 14:21:43 +00:00
|
|
|
The default permits direct access to the terminal attached to the window.
|
2010-04-05 05:11:44 +00:00
|
|
|
The other is copy mode, which permits a section of a window or its
|
|
|
|
history to be copied to a
|
2007-11-24 14:21:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em paste buffer
|
|
|
|
for later insertion into another window.
|
|
|
|
This mode is entered with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic copy-mode
|
|
|
|
command, bound to
|
2009-10-25 10:42:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql \&[
|
2007-11-24 18:05:39 +00:00
|
|
|
by default.
|
2010-04-05 05:11:44 +00:00
|
|
|
It is also entered when a command that produces output, such as
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-keys ,
|
|
|
|
is executed from a key binding.
|
2009-02-01 18:11:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
Commands are sent to copy mode using the
|
|
|
|
.Fl X
|
|
|
|
flag to the
|
|
|
|
.Ic send-keys
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
When a key is pressed, copy mode automatically uses one of two key tables,
|
|
|
|
depending on the
|
2008-11-17 17:41:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic mode-keys
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
option:
|
|
|
|
.Ic copy-mode
|
|
|
|
for emacs, or
|
|
|
|
.Ic copy-mode-vi
|
|
|
|
for vi.
|
|
|
|
Key tables may be viewed with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-keys
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The following commands are supported in copy mode:
|
2019-05-13 08:56:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -column "CommandXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX" "viXXXXXXXXXX" "emacs" -offset indent
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Sy "Command" Ta Sy "vi" Ta Sy "emacs"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "append-selection" Ta "" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "append-selection-and-cancel" Ta "A" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "back-to-indentation" Ta "^" Ta "M-m"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "begin-selection" Ta "Space" Ta "C-Space"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "bottom-line" Ta "L" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "cancel" Ta "q" Ta "Escape"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "clear-selection" Ta "Escape" Ta "C-g"
|
2019-04-02 09:03:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-end-of-line [<prefix>]" Ta "D" Ta "C-k"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-line [<prefix>]" Ta "" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-pipe <command> [<prefix>]" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2019-04-23 09:39:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-pipe-no-clear <command> [<prefix>]" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2019-04-02 09:03:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-pipe-and-cancel <command> [<prefix>]" Ta "" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-selection [<prefix>]" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2019-04-23 09:39:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-selection-no-clear [<prefix>]" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2019-04-02 09:03:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "copy-selection-and-cancel [<prefix>]" Ta "Enter" Ta "M-w"
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor-down" Ta "j" Ta "Down"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor-left" Ta "h" Ta "Left"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor-right" Ta "l" Ta "Right"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor-up" Ta "k" Ta "Up"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "end-of-line" Ta "$" Ta "C-e"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "goto-line <line>" Ta ":" Ta "g"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "halfpage-down" Ta "C-d" Ta "M-Down"
|
2017-11-16 11:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "halfpage-down-and-cancel" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "halfpage-up" Ta "C-u" Ta "M-Up"
|
2017-11-16 11:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "history-bottom" Ta "G" Ta "M->"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "history-top" Ta "g" Ta "M-<"
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "jump-again" Ta ";" Ta ";"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "jump-backward <to>" Ta "F" Ta "F"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "jump-forward <to>" Ta "f" Ta "f"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "jump-reverse" Ta "," Ta ","
|
|
|
|
.It Li "jump-to-backward <to>" Ta "T" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "jump-to-forward <to>" Ta "t" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "middle-line" Ta "M" Ta "M-r"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "next-paragraph" Ta "}" Ta "M-}"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "next-space" Ta "W" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "next-space-end" Ta "E" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "next-word" Ta "w" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "next-word-end" Ta "e" Ta "M-f"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "other-end" Ta "o" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "page-down" Ta "C-f" Ta "PageDown"
|
2017-11-16 11:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "page-down-and-cancel" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "page-up" Ta "C-b" Ta "PageUp"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "previous-paragraph" Ta "{" Ta "M-{"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "previous-space" Ta "B" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "previous-word" Ta "b" Ta "M-b"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "rectangle-toggle" Ta "v" Ta "R"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "scroll-down" Ta "C-e" Ta "C-Down"
|
2017-11-16 11:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "scroll-down-and-cancel" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "scroll-up" Ta "C-y" Ta "C-Up"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "search-again" Ta "n" Ta "n"
|
2017-01-06 11:57:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "search-backward <for>" Ta "?" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "search-forward <for>" Ta "/" Ta ""
|
|
|
|
.It Li "search-backward-incremental <for>" Ta "" Ta "C-r"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "search-forward-incremental <for>" Ta "" Ta "C-s"
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "search-reverse" Ta "N" Ta "N"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "select-line" Ta "V" Ta ""
|
2019-04-08 17:55:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "select-word" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "start-of-line" Ta "0" Ta "C-a"
|
2016-11-24 13:38:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "stop-selection" Ta "" Ta ""
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "top-line" Ta "H" Ta "M-R"
|
2008-11-17 17:41:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-04-02 09:03:39 +00:00
|
|
|
Copy commands may take an optional buffer prefix argument which is used
|
|
|
|
to generate the buffer name (the default is
|
|
|
|
.Ql buffer
|
|
|
|
so buffers are named
|
|
|
|
.Ql buffer0 ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql buffer1
|
|
|
|
and so on).
|
|
|
|
Pipe commands take a command argument which is the command to which the
|
|
|
|
copied text is piped.
|
2017-11-16 11:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ql -and-cancel
|
|
|
|
variants of some commands exit copy mode after they have completed (for copy
|
|
|
|
commands) or when the cursor reaches the bottom (for scrolling commands).
|
2019-04-23 09:39:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql -no-clear
|
|
|
|
variants do not clear the selection.
|
2017-11-16 11:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-02-05 01:34:08 +00:00
|
|
|
The next and previous word keys use space and the
|
|
|
|
.Ql - ,
|
2010-02-26 13:31:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql _
|
2010-02-05 01:34:08 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql @
|
2010-02-26 13:31:39 +00:00
|
|
|
characters as word delimiters by default, but this can be adjusted by
|
|
|
|
setting the
|
|
|
|
.Em word-separators
|
2011-11-25 13:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
session option.
|
2010-02-05 01:34:08 +00:00
|
|
|
Next word moves to the start of the next word, next word end to the end of the
|
|
|
|
next word and previous word to the start of the previous word.
|
|
|
|
The three next and previous space keys work similarly but use a space alone as
|
|
|
|
the word separator.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-03-16 17:30:58 +00:00
|
|
|
The jump commands enable quick movement within a line.
|
2010-03-16 17:51:32 +00:00
|
|
|
For instance, typing
|
|
|
|
.Ql f
|
|
|
|
followed by
|
|
|
|
.Ql /
|
|
|
|
will move the cursor to the next
|
|
|
|
.Ql /
|
|
|
|
character on the current line.
|
|
|
|
A
|
2010-03-16 17:30:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql \&;
|
2010-03-16 17:51:32 +00:00
|
|
|
will then jump to the next occurrence.
|
2010-03-16 17:30:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-03-08 15:02:07 +00:00
|
|
|
Commands in copy mode may be prefaced by an optional repeat count.
|
|
|
|
With vi key bindings, a prefix is entered using the number keys; with
|
|
|
|
emacs, the Alt (meta) key and a number begins prefix entry.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-04-05 05:11:44 +00:00
|
|
|
The synopsis for the
|
|
|
|
.Ic copy-mode
|
|
|
|
command is:
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic copy-mode
|
2015-09-13 13:31:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl Meu
|
2009-08-20 11:37:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Enter copy mode.
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl u
|
|
|
|
option scrolls one page up.
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl M
|
|
|
|
begins a mouse drag (only valid if bound to a mouse key binding, see
|
2015-04-19 22:10:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx MOUSE SUPPORT ) .
|
2015-09-13 13:31:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
|
|
|
specifies that scrolling to the bottom of the history (to the visible screen)
|
|
|
|
should exit copy mode.
|
|
|
|
While in copy mode, pressing a key other than those used for scrolling will
|
|
|
|
disable this behaviour.
|
|
|
|
This is intended to allow fast scrolling through a pane's history, for
|
|
|
|
example with:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
bind PageUp copy-mode -eu
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-07-08 17:57:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
Each window displayed by
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
may be split into one or more
|
|
|
|
.Em panes ;
|
|
|
|
each pane takes up a certain area of the display and is a separate terminal.
|
|
|
|
A window may be split into panes using the
|
|
|
|
.Ic split-window
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2009-07-20 15:42:05 +00:00
|
|
|
Windows may be split horizontally (with the
|
|
|
|
.Fl h
|
|
|
|
flag) or vertically.
|
|
|
|
Panes may be resized with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic resize-pane
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
command (bound to
|
2017-01-10 10:08:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql C-Up ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-Down
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-Left
|
2009-07-20 15:42:05 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
2017-01-10 10:08:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql C-Right
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
by default), the current pane may be changed with the
|
2010-03-15 22:03:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic select-pane
|
|
|
|
command and the
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic rotate-window
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic swap-pane
|
2009-07-20 15:42:05 +00:00
|
|
|
commands may be used to swap panes without changing their position.
|
|
|
|
Panes are numbered beginning from zero in the order they are created.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
A number of preset
|
|
|
|
.Em layouts
|
|
|
|
are available.
|
|
|
|
These may be selected with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-layout
|
|
|
|
command or cycled with
|
|
|
|
.Ic next-layout
|
|
|
|
(bound to
|
2010-02-08 18:31:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql Space
|
2009-12-04 22:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
by default); once a layout is chosen, panes within it may be moved and resized
|
|
|
|
as normal.
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The following layouts are supported:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Ic even-horizontal
|
|
|
|
Panes are spread out evenly from left to right across the window.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic even-vertical
|
|
|
|
Panes are spread evenly from top to bottom.
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic main-horizontal
|
2009-12-04 22:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
A large (main) pane is shown at the top of the window and the remaining panes
|
|
|
|
are spread from left to right in the leftover space at the bottom.
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
Use the
|
|
|
|
.Em main-pane-height
|
|
|
|
window option to specify the height of the top pane.
|
2009-05-18 21:58:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic main-vertical
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
Similar to
|
|
|
|
.Ic main-horizontal
|
|
|
|
but the large pane is placed on the left and the others spread from top to
|
|
|
|
bottom along the right.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Em main-pane-width
|
|
|
|
window option.
|
2010-05-14 14:16:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic tiled
|
|
|
|
Panes are spread out as evenly as possible over the window in both rows and
|
|
|
|
columns.
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-07-02 02:54:52 +00:00
|
|
|
In addition,
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-layout
|
|
|
|
may be used to apply a previously used layout - the
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-windows
|
|
|
|
command displays the layout of each window in a form suitable for use with
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-layout .
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ tmux list-windows
|
|
|
|
0: ksh [159x48]
|
|
|
|
layout: bb62,159x48,0,0{79x48,0,0,79x48,80,0}
|
|
|
|
$ tmux select-layout bb62,159x48,0,0{79x48,0,0,79x48,80,0}
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2010-12-27 21:13:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-07-02 02:54:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
automatically adjusts the size of the layout for the current window size.
|
|
|
|
Note that a layout cannot be applied to a window with more panes than that
|
|
|
|
from which the layout was originally defined.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Commands related to windows and panes are as follows:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic break-pane
|
2012-03-18 01:38:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl dP
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2017-01-29 22:10:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl n Ar window-name
|
2015-06-17 19:56:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar src-pane
|
2016-03-01 11:58:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar dst-window
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic breakp )
|
|
|
|
Break
|
2015-06-17 19:56:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
off from its containing window to make it the only pane in
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-window .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
is given, the new window does not become the current window.
|
2012-03-18 01:38:27 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl P
|
|
|
|
option prints information about the new window after it has been created.
|
|
|
|
By default, it uses the format
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{session_name}:#{window_index}
|
|
|
|
but a different format may be specified with
|
|
|
|
.Fl F .
|
2009-12-02 15:10:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic capture-pane
|
2016-10-14 17:40:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl aepPqCJ
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b Ar buffer-name
|
2011-04-06 22:19:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl E Ar end-line
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl S Ar start-line
|
2009-12-02 15:10:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic capturep )
|
2013-02-15 09:31:45 +00:00
|
|
|
Capture the contents of a pane.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
2013-02-19 09:51:04 +00:00
|
|
|
is given, the output goes to stdout, otherwise to the buffer specified with
|
2013-02-15 09:31:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl b
|
|
|
|
or a new buffer if omitted.
|
2013-02-19 09:55:02 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
2013-02-24 07:52:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
is given, the alternate screen is used, and the history is not accessible.
|
2013-03-04 09:00:24 +00:00
|
|
|
If no alternate screen exists, an error will be returned unless
|
|
|
|
.Fl q
|
|
|
|
is given.
|
2013-02-24 07:52:03 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
2013-02-19 09:55:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
2013-02-21 09:35:01 +00:00
|
|
|
is given, the output includes escape sequences for text and background
|
|
|
|
attributes.
|
|
|
|
.Fl C
|
2013-03-25 11:49:54 +00:00
|
|
|
also escapes non-printable characters as octal \exxx.
|
2013-02-21 09:35:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl J
|
2013-03-04 11:03:03 +00:00
|
|
|
joins wrapped lines and preserves trailing spaces at each line's end.
|
2013-03-11 13:47:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl P
|
|
|
|
captures only any output that the pane has received that is the beginning of an
|
|
|
|
as-yet incomplete escape sequence.
|
2011-04-06 22:19:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl S
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl E
|
|
|
|
specify the starting and ending line numbers, zero is the first line of the
|
|
|
|
visible pane and negative numbers are lines in the history.
|
2014-06-20 10:46:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql -
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Fl S
|
|
|
|
is the start of the history and to
|
|
|
|
.Fl E
|
|
|
|
the end of the visible pane.
|
2011-04-06 22:19:42 +00:00
|
|
|
The default is to capture only the visible contents of the pane.
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo
|
|
|
|
.Ic choose-client
|
2018-02-28 08:55:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl NZ
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl f Ar filter
|
2017-06-09 15:29:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl O Ar sort-order
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar template
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
Put a pane into client mode, allowing a client to be selected interactively from
|
|
|
|
a list.
|
2018-02-28 08:55:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl Z
|
|
|
|
zooms the pane.
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
The following keys may be used in client mode:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "Key" "Function" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Key" Ta Sy "Function"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Enter" Ta "Choose selected client"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Up" Ta "Select previous client"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Down" Ta "Select next client"
|
2017-06-07 14:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "C-s" Ta "Search by name"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "n" Ta "Repeat last search"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "t" Ta "Toggle if client is tagged"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "T" Ta "Tag no clients"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "C-t" Ta "Tag all clients"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "d" Ta "Detach selected client"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "D" Ta "Detach tagged clients"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "x" Ta "Detach and HUP selected client"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "X" Ta "Detach and HUP tagged clients"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "z" Ta "Suspend selected client"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Z" Ta "Suspend tagged clients"
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "f" Ta "Enter a format to filter items"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "O" Ta "Change sort order"
|
2017-08-23 09:39:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "v" Ta "Toggle preview"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "q" Ta "Exit mode"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
After a client is chosen,
|
|
|
|
.Ql %%
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
is replaced by the client name in
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
and the result executed as a command.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
is not given, "detach-client -t '%%'" is used.
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-06-09 15:29:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl O
|
|
|
|
specifies the initial sort order: one of
|
|
|
|
.Ql name ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql size ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql creation ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql activity .
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl f
|
2017-09-11 06:53:06 +00:00
|
|
|
specifies an initial filter: the filter is a format - if it evaluates to zero,
|
|
|
|
the item in the list is not shown, otherwise it is shown.
|
|
|
|
If a filter would lead to an empty list, it is ignored.
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
specifies the format for each item in the list.
|
2017-08-23 09:39:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl N
|
|
|
|
starts without the preview.
|
2013-02-10 17:52:51 +00:00
|
|
|
This command works only if at least one client is attached.
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic choose-tree
|
2018-02-28 08:55:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl GNswZ
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl f Ar filter
|
2017-06-09 15:29:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl O Ar sort-order
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar template
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
Put a pane into tree mode, where a session, window or pane may be chosen
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
interactively from a list.
|
2012-07-11 17:13:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
starts with sessions collapsed and
|
2012-07-11 17:13:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl w
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
with windows collapsed.
|
2018-02-28 08:55:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl Z
|
|
|
|
zooms the pane.
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
The following keys may be used in tree mode:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "Key" "Function" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Key" Ta Sy "Function"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Enter" Ta "Choose selected item"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Up" Ta "Select previous item"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Down" Ta "Select next item"
|
2018-04-10 10:48:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "x" Ta "Kill selected item"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "X" Ta "Kill tagged items"
|
2017-07-04 22:21:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "<" Ta "Scroll list of previews left"
|
|
|
|
.It Li ">" Ta "Scroll list of previews right"
|
2017-06-07 14:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "C-s" Ta "Search by name"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "n" Ta "Repeat last search"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "t" Ta "Toggle if item is tagged"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "T" Ta "Tag no items"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "C-t" Ta "Tag all items"
|
2017-06-04 08:02:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "\&:" Ta "Run a command for each tagged item"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "f" Ta "Enter a format to filter items"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "O" Ta "Change sort order"
|
2017-08-23 09:39:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "v" Ta "Toggle preview"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "q" Ta "Exit mode"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
2013-02-13 11:07:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
After a session, window or pane is chosen,
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql %%
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
is replaced by the target in
|
2009-08-25 13:53:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
and the result executed as a command.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
is not given, "switch-client -t '%%'" is used.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-06-09 15:29:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl O
|
|
|
|
specifies the initial sort order: one of
|
|
|
|
.Ql index ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql name ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql time .
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl f
|
2017-09-11 06:53:06 +00:00
|
|
|
specifies an initial filter: the filter is a format - if it evaluates to zero,
|
|
|
|
the item in the list is not shown, otherwise it is shown.
|
|
|
|
If a filter would lead to an empty list, it is ignored.
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
specifies the format for each item in the tree.
|
2017-08-23 09:39:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl N
|
|
|
|
starts without the preview.
|
2017-11-02 18:27:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl G
|
|
|
|
includes all sessions in any session groups in the tree rather than only the
|
|
|
|
first.
|
2013-02-10 17:52:51 +00:00
|
|
|
This command works only if at least one client is attached.
|
2016-06-16 10:55:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes
|
2019-02-06 07:36:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b
|
2017-08-16 12:12:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl d Ar duration
|
2016-06-16 10:55:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.Op Ar template
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2014-08-11 22:14:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic displayp )
|
2009-08-31 22:30:15 +00:00
|
|
|
Display a visible indicator of each pane shown by
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-client .
|
|
|
|
See the
|
2017-08-16 12:12:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes-colour
|
2009-08-31 22:30:15 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
2010-02-05 01:31:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes-active-colour
|
2009-08-31 22:30:15 +00:00
|
|
|
session options.
|
2017-08-16 12:12:54 +00:00
|
|
|
The indicator is closed when a key is pressed or
|
|
|
|
.Ar duration
|
|
|
|
milliseconds have passed.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
is not given,
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes-time
|
|
|
|
is used.
|
|
|
|
A duration of zero means the indicator stays until a key is pressed.
|
2016-06-16 10:55:47 +00:00
|
|
|
While the indicator is on screen, a pane may be chosen with the
|
2009-09-08 00:01:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql 0
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Ql 9
|
2016-06-16 10:55:47 +00:00
|
|
|
keys, which will cause
|
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
to be executed as a command with
|
|
|
|
.Ql %%
|
|
|
|
substituted by the pane ID.
|
|
|
|
The default
|
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
is "select-pane -t '%%'".
|
2019-02-06 07:36:06 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl b ,
|
|
|
|
other commands are not blocked from running until the indicator is closed.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic find-window
|
2019-06-20 20:31:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl rCNTZ
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar match-string
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic findw )
|
2019-06-20 20:31:04 +00:00
|
|
|
Search for a
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr fnmatch 3
|
2019-06-20 20:31:04 +00:00
|
|
|
pattern or, with
|
|
|
|
.Fl r ,
|
|
|
|
regular expression
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar match-string
|
|
|
|
in window names, titles, and visible content (but not history).
|
2012-03-29 21:07:28 +00:00
|
|
|
The flags control matching behavior:
|
|
|
|
.Fl C
|
|
|
|
matches only visible window contents,
|
|
|
|
.Fl N
|
|
|
|
matches only the window name and
|
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
matches only the window title.
|
|
|
|
The default is
|
|
|
|
.Fl CNT .
|
2018-08-20 15:00:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl Z
|
|
|
|
zooms the pane.
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2013-02-10 17:52:51 +00:00
|
|
|
This command works only if at least one client is attached.
|
2010-01-08 16:31:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic join-pane
|
2012-03-03 09:19:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl bdhv
|
2010-01-08 16:31:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Oo Fl l
|
|
|
|
.Ar size |
|
|
|
|
.Fl p Ar percentage Oc
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar dst-pane
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic joinp )
|
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ic split-window ,
|
|
|
|
but instead of splitting
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-pane
|
|
|
|
and creating a new pane, split it and move
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
into the space.
|
|
|
|
This can be used to reverse
|
|
|
|
.Ic break-pane .
|
2012-03-03 09:19:40 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl b
|
|
|
|
option causes
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
to be joined to left of or above
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-pane .
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
is omitted and a marked pane is present (see
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-pane
|
|
|
|
.Fl m ) ,
|
|
|
|
the marked pane is used rather than the current pane.
|
2009-10-25 10:41:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic kill-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl a
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic killp )
|
|
|
|
Destroy the given pane.
|
|
|
|
If no panes remain in the containing window, it is also destroyed.
|
2009-10-25 10:41:03 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
option kills all but the pane given with
|
|
|
|
.Fl t .
|
2012-04-24 16:19:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic kill-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl a
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic killw )
|
|
|
|
Kill the current window or the window at
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-window ,
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
removing it from any sessions to which it is linked.
|
2012-04-24 16:19:27 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
option kills all but the window given with
|
|
|
|
.Fl t .
|
2014-08-11 22:14:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic last-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl de
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2010-10-24 01:34:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lastp )
|
|
|
|
Select the last (previously selected) pane.
|
2014-08-11 22:14:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
|
|
|
enables or
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
disables input to the pane.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic last-window Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic last )
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
Select the last (previously selected) window.
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
If no
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session
|
2008-06-17 06:22:15 +00:00
|
|
|
is specified, select the last window of the current session.
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic link-window
|
2015-06-17 16:50:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl adk
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar src-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar dst-window
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic linkw )
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
Link the window at
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar src-window
|
|
|
|
to the specified
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-window .
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-window
|
|
|
|
is specified and no such window exists, the
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-window
|
|
|
|
is linked there.
|
2015-06-17 16:50:28 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl a ,
|
|
|
|
the window is moved to the next index up (following windows
|
|
|
|
are moved if necessary).
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
2007-11-17 08:21:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl k
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
is given and
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-window
|
|
|
|
exists, it is killed, otherwise an error is generated.
|
2007-11-17 08:21:54 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
is given, the newly linked window is not selected.
|
2011-04-06 22:20:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic list-panes
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl as
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2011-04-06 22:20:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-10-12 00:08:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lsp )
|
2011-04-06 22:20:16 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
is given,
|
|
|
|
.Ar target
|
|
|
|
is ignored and all panes on the server are listed.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
is given,
|
|
|
|
.Ar target
|
|
|
|
is a session (or the current session).
|
|
|
|
If neither is given,
|
|
|
|
.Ar target
|
|
|
|
is a window (or the current window).
|
2011-10-02 11:31:34 +00:00
|
|
|
For the meaning of the
|
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
flag, see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2011-04-06 22:20:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic list-windows
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl a
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2011-04-06 22:20:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lsw )
|
2011-04-06 22:20:16 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
is given, list all windows on the server.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, list windows in the current session or in
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-session .
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
For the meaning of the
|
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
flag, see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2012-03-03 09:19:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic move-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl bdhv
|
|
|
|
.Oo Fl l
|
|
|
|
.Ar size |
|
|
|
|
.Fl p Ar percentage Oc
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar dst-pane
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic movep )
|
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ic join-pane ,
|
|
|
|
but
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-pane
|
|
|
|
may belong to the same window.
|
2008-06-27 17:24:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic move-window
|
2015-06-17 16:50:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl ardk
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar src-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar dst-window
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic movew )
|
|
|
|
This is similar to
|
|
|
|
.Ic link-window ,
|
|
|
|
except the window at
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-window
|
|
|
|
is moved to
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-window .
|
2012-05-03 17:51:04 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl r ,
|
|
|
|
all windows in the session are renumbered in sequential order, respecting
|
|
|
|
the
|
|
|
|
.Ic base-index
|
|
|
|
option.
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic new-window
|
2011-01-03 23:29:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl adkP
|
2012-02-02 01:55:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar start-directory
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl e Ar environment
|
2013-03-22 17:01:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl n Ar window-name
|
2008-06-18 16:39:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar shell-command
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic neww )
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
Create a new window.
|
2010-03-27 15:12:11 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl a ,
|
|
|
|
the new window is inserted at the next index up from the specified
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-window ,
|
|
|
|
moving windows up if necessary,
|
|
|
|
otherwise
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
is the new window location.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
is given, the session does not make the new window the current window.
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-window
|
2009-07-14 06:39:44 +00:00
|
|
|
represents the window to be created; if the target already exists an error is
|
|
|
|
shown, unless the
|
|
|
|
.Fl k
|
|
|
|
flag is used, in which case it is destroyed.
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
is the command to execute.
|
|
|
|
If
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
is not specified, the value of the
|
|
|
|
.Ic default-command
|
|
|
|
option is used.
|
2012-02-02 01:55:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl c
|
|
|
|
specifies the working directory in which the new window is created.
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
When the shell command completes, the window closes.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Ic remain-on-exit
|
|
|
|
option to change this behaviour.
|
2007-11-12 20:42:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
|
|
|
takes the form
|
|
|
|
.Ql VARIABLE=value
|
|
|
|
and sets an environment variable for the newly created window; it may be
|
|
|
|
specified multiple times.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2007-11-12 20:42:53 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ev TERM
|
|
|
|
environment variable must be set to
|
2017-01-10 10:08:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql screen
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql tmux
|
2008-06-05 21:25:00 +00:00
|
|
|
for all programs running
|
2007-11-12 20:42:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em inside
|
|
|
|
.Nm .
|
|
|
|
New windows will automatically have
|
2017-01-10 10:08:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql TERM=screen
|
2007-11-12 20:42:53 +00:00
|
|
|
added to their environment, but care must be taken not to reset this in shell
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
start-up files or by the
|
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
|
|
|
option.
|
2011-01-03 23:29:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl P
|
2012-03-07 13:39:29 +00:00
|
|
|
option prints information about the new window after it has been created.
|
|
|
|
By default, it uses the format
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{session_name}:#{window_index}
|
|
|
|
but a different format may be specified with
|
|
|
|
.Fl F .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic next-layout Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic nextl )
|
|
|
|
Move a window to the next layout and rearrange the panes to fit.
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic next-window
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl a
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic next )
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
Move to the next window in the session.
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
2012-06-18 15:10:40 +00:00
|
|
|
is used, move to the next window with an alert.
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic pipe-pane
|
2018-01-16 09:00:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl IOo
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar shell-command
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic pipep )
|
2018-01-16 09:00:38 +00:00
|
|
|
Pipe output sent by the program in
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane
|
2018-01-16 09:00:38 +00:00
|
|
|
to a shell command or vice versa.
|
|
|
|
A pane may only be connected to one command at a time, any existing pipe is
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
closed before
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
is executed.
|
2010-06-06 00:28:00 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
string may contain the special character sequences supported by the
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-left
|
2011-05-22 16:26:38 +00:00
|
|
|
option.
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
If no
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
is given, the current pipe (if any) is closed.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2018-01-16 09:00:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl I
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl O
|
|
|
|
specify which of the
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
output streams are connected to the pane:
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl I
|
|
|
|
stdout is connected (so anything
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
prints is written to the pane as if it were typed);
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl O
|
|
|
|
stdin is connected (so any output in the pane is piped to
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command ) .
|
|
|
|
Both may be used together and if neither are specified,
|
|
|
|
.Fl O
|
|
|
|
is used.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl o
|
|
|
|
option only opens a new pipe if no previous pipe exists, allowing a pipe to
|
|
|
|
be toggled with a single key, for example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2010-06-06 00:28:00 +00:00
|
|
|
bind-key C-p pipe-pane -o 'cat >>~/output.#I-#P'
|
2009-10-12 00:35:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2010-06-15 20:24:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic previous-layout
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic prevl )
|
|
|
|
Move to the previous layout in the session.
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic previous-window
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl a
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic prev )
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
Move to the previous window in the session.
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl a ,
|
2012-06-18 15:10:40 +00:00
|
|
|
move to the previous window with an alert.
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic rename-window
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar new-name
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic renamew )
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
Rename the current window, or the window at
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-window
|
2009-02-08 18:41:03 +00:00
|
|
|
if specified, to
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar new-name .
|
2009-04-30 06:01:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic resize-pane
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl DLMRUZ
|
2009-07-30 20:45:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2013-02-18 17:00:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl x Ar width
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl y Ar height
|
2009-01-16 17:28:49 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-04-30 06:01:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic resizep )
|
2013-02-18 17:00:35 +00:00
|
|
|
Resize a pane, up, down, left or right by
|
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl U ,
|
2009-07-20 15:42:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl D ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl L
|
2013-02-18 17:00:35 +00:00
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Fl R ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
to an absolute size
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl x
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Fl y .
|
2009-02-07 08:22:11 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
2009-01-16 17:28:49 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment
|
2009-07-20 15:42:05 +00:00
|
|
|
is given in lines or cells (the default is 1).
|
2013-02-24 00:25:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl Z ,
|
2013-03-12 14:58:48 +00:00
|
|
|
the active pane is toggled between zoomed (occupying the whole of the window)
|
|
|
|
and unzoomed (its normal position in the layout).
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl M
|
|
|
|
begins mouse resizing (only valid if bound to a mouse key binding, see
|
2015-04-19 22:10:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx MOUSE SUPPORT ) .
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic resize-window
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl aADLRU
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl x Ar width
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl y Ar height
|
|
|
|
.Op Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic resizew )
|
|
|
|
Resize a window, up, down, left or right by
|
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl U ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl D ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl L
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Fl R ,
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
or
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
to an absolute size
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl x
|
|
|
|
or
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl y .
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ar adjustment
|
|
|
|
is given in lines or cells (the default is 1).
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl A
|
|
|
|
sets the size of the largest session containing the window;
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
the size of the smallest.
|
|
|
|
This command will automatically set
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic window-size
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
to manual in the window options.
|
2011-06-23 19:23:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic respawn-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl k
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar start-directory
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl e Ar environment
|
2011-06-23 19:23:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic respawnp )
|
|
|
|
Reactivate a pane in which the command has exited (see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic remain-on-exit
|
|
|
|
window option).
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
is not given, the command used when the pane was created is executed.
|
|
|
|
The pane must be already inactive, unless
|
|
|
|
.Fl k
|
|
|
|
is given, in which case any existing command is killed.
|
2017-07-21 09:17:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl c
|
|
|
|
specifies a new working directory for the pane.
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
|
|
|
option has the same meaning as for the
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2009-01-12 21:23:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic respawn-window
|
2008-06-30 18:27:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl k
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar start-directory
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl e Ar environment
|
2008-06-30 18:27:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar shell-command
|
2008-06-30 18:27:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic respawnw )
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
Reactivate a window in which the command has exited (see the
|
2009-02-08 18:41:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic remain-on-exit
|
|
|
|
window option).
|
2008-06-30 18:27:14 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
2008-06-30 18:27:14 +00:00
|
|
|
is not given, the command used when the window was created is executed.
|
|
|
|
The window must be already inactive, unless
|
|
|
|
.Fl k
|
|
|
|
is given, in which case any existing command is killed.
|
2017-07-21 09:17:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl c
|
|
|
|
specifies a new working directory for the window.
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
|
|
|
option has the same meaning as for the
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic rotate-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl DU
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic rotatew )
|
|
|
|
Rotate the positions of the panes within a window, either upward (numerically
|
|
|
|
lower) with
|
|
|
|
.Fl U
|
|
|
|
or downward (numerically higher).
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic select-layout
|
2017-11-15 19:59:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl Enop
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-07-28 23:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar layout-name
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2010-06-15 20:24:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic selectl )
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
Choose a specific layout for a window.
|
2009-07-28 23:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar layout-name
|
2010-07-02 02:54:52 +00:00
|
|
|
is not given, the last preset layout used (if any) is reapplied.
|
2011-01-07 15:02:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
|
|
|
are equivalent to the
|
|
|
|
.Ic next-layout
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic previous-layout
|
|
|
|
commands.
|
2015-04-28 10:43:13 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl o
|
|
|
|
applies the last set layout if possible (undoes the most recent layout change).
|
2017-11-15 19:59:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl E
|
|
|
|
spreads the current pane and any panes next to it out evenly.
|
2010-03-15 22:03:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic select-pane
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl DdeLlMmRU
|
2017-09-02 17:51:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl T Ar title
|
2010-03-15 22:03:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-01-16 17:28:49 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic selectp )
|
|
|
|
Make pane
|
2009-07-30 20:45:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane
|
2009-01-16 17:28:49 +00:00
|
|
|
the active pane in window
|
2019-06-21 07:11:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-window.
|
2010-03-15 22:03:38 +00:00
|
|
|
If one of
|
|
|
|
.Fl D ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl L ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl R ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Fl U
|
|
|
|
is used, respectively the pane below, to the left, to the right, or above the
|
|
|
|
target pane is used.
|
2011-01-07 15:02:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl l
|
|
|
|
is the same as using the
|
|
|
|
.Ic last-pane
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2014-08-11 22:14:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl e
|
|
|
|
enables or
|
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
disables input to the pane.
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
sets the pane title.
|
2015-04-19 21:05:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl m
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl M
|
|
|
|
are used to set and clear the
|
|
|
|
.Em marked pane .
|
|
|
|
There is one marked pane at a time, setting a new marked pane clears the last.
|
|
|
|
The marked pane is the default target for
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Ic join-pane ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic swap-pane
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic swap-window .
|
2011-01-07 15:02:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic select-window
|
2012-12-24 12:38:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl lnpT
|
2011-01-07 15:02:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic selectw )
|
|
|
|
Select the window at
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-window .
|
2011-01-07 15:02:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl l ,
|
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
|
|
|
are equivalent to the
|
|
|
|
.Ic last-window ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic next-window
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic previous-window
|
|
|
|
commands.
|
2012-12-24 12:38:57 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
is given and the selected window is already the current window,
|
|
|
|
the command behaves like
|
|
|
|
.Ic last-window .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic split-window
|
2019-05-03 20:44:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl bdfhIvP
|
2012-02-02 01:55:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar start-directory
|
2019-04-28 20:05:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl e Ar environment
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Oo Fl l
|
|
|
|
.Ar size |
|
|
|
|
.Fl p Ar percentage Oc
|
2010-01-08 16:23:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar shell-command
|
2012-03-07 13:39:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2008-06-27 17:24:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2010-06-15 20:24:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic splitw )
|
2010-01-08 16:23:38 +00:00
|
|
|
Create a new pane by splitting
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane :
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl h
|
|
|
|
does a horizontal split and
|
|
|
|
.Fl v
|
|
|
|
a vertical split; if neither is specified,
|
|
|
|
.Fl v
|
|
|
|
is assumed.
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl l
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
2010-01-08 16:23:38 +00:00
|
|
|
options specify the size of the new pane in lines (for vertical split) or in
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
cells (for horizontal split), or as a percentage, respectively.
|
2014-11-12 22:57:06 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl b
|
|
|
|
option causes the new pane to be created to the left of or above
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane .
|
2016-09-04 17:37:06 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl f
|
|
|
|
option creates a new pane spanning the full window height (with
|
|
|
|
.Fl h )
|
|
|
|
or full window width (with
|
|
|
|
.Fl v ) ,
|
|
|
|
instead of splitting the active pane.
|
2019-05-03 20:44:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
An empty
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
('') will create a pane with no command running in it.
|
|
|
|
Output can be sent to such a pane with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-message
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl I
|
|
|
|
flag (if
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
is not specified or empty)
|
|
|
|
will create an empty pane and forward any output from stdin to it.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ make 2>&1|tmux splitw -dI &
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-01-08 16:23:38 +00:00
|
|
|
All other options have the same meaning as for the
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic swap-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl dDU
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar src-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar dst-pane
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic swapp )
|
|
|
|
Swap two panes.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl U
|
|
|
|
is used and no source pane is specified with
|
|
|
|
.Fl s ,
|
|
|
|
.Ar dst-pane
|
|
|
|
is swapped with the previous pane (before it numerically);
|
|
|
|
.Fl D
|
|
|
|
swaps with the next pane (after it numerically).
|
2010-01-17 19:02:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl d
|
|
|
|
instructs
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
not to change the active pane.
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
is omitted and a marked pane is present (see
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-pane
|
|
|
|
.Fl m ) ,
|
|
|
|
the marked pane is used rather than the current pane.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic swap-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl d
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar src-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar dst-window
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic swapw )
|
|
|
|
This is similar to
|
|
|
|
.Ic link-window ,
|
|
|
|
except the source and destination windows are swapped.
|
|
|
|
It is an error if no window exists at
|
|
|
|
.Ar src-window .
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ic swap-pane ,
|
|
|
|
if
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
is omitted and a marked pane is present (see
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-pane
|
|
|
|
.Fl m ) ,
|
|
|
|
the window containing the marked pane is used rather than the current window.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic unlink-window
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl k
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-window
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic unlinkw )
|
|
|
|
Unlink
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-window .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Unless
|
|
|
|
.Fl k
|
|
|
|
is given, a window may be unlinked only if it is linked to multiple sessions -
|
|
|
|
windows may not be linked to no sessions;
|
|
|
|
if
|
|
|
|
.Fl k
|
|
|
|
is specified and the window is linked to only one session, it is unlinked and
|
|
|
|
destroyed.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Sh KEY BINDINGS
|
2009-10-05 18:21:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
allows a command to be bound to most keys, with or without a prefix key.
|
|
|
|
When specifying keys, most represent themselves (for example
|
|
|
|
.Ql A
|
|
|
|
to
|
2009-10-05 18:26:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql Z ) .
|
2009-10-05 18:21:58 +00:00
|
|
|
Ctrl keys may be prefixed with
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-
|
|
|
|
or
|
2009-10-05 18:26:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql ^ ,
|
|
|
|
and Alt (meta) with
|
2009-10-05 18:21:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql M- .
|
|
|
|
In addition, the following special key names are accepted:
|
2009-11-28 14:38:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em Up ,
|
|
|
|
.Em Down ,
|
|
|
|
.Em Left ,
|
|
|
|
.Em Right ,
|
2009-10-05 18:21:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em BSpace ,
|
|
|
|
.Em BTab ,
|
|
|
|
.Em DC
|
|
|
|
(Delete),
|
|
|
|
.Em End ,
|
|
|
|
.Em Enter ,
|
|
|
|
.Em Escape ,
|
|
|
|
.Em F1
|
|
|
|
to
|
2014-10-02 14:21:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em F12 ,
|
2009-10-05 18:21:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em Home ,
|
|
|
|
.Em IC
|
|
|
|
(Insert),
|
2011-11-10 21:41:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em NPage/PageDown/PgDn ,
|
|
|
|
.Em PPage/PageUp/PgUp ,
|
2009-10-05 18:21:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em Space ,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Em Tab .
|
|
|
|
Note that to bind the
|
|
|
|
.Ql \&"
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql '
|
|
|
|
keys, quotation marks are necessary, for example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
bind-key '"' split-window
|
2010-05-14 14:33:39 +00:00
|
|
|
bind-key "'" new-window
|
2009-10-05 18:21:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Commands related to key bindings are as follows:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic bind-key
|
2016-10-12 15:26:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl nr
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl T Ar key-table
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar key Ar command Op Ar arguments
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic bind )
|
|
|
|
Bind key
|
|
|
|
.Ar key
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Ar command .
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
Keys are bound in a key table.
|
|
|
|
By default (without -T), the key is bound in
|
|
|
|
the
|
|
|
|
.Em prefix
|
|
|
|
key table.
|
|
|
|
This table is used for keys pressed after the prefix key (for example,
|
|
|
|
by default
|
|
|
|
.Ql c
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
is bound to
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
in the
|
|
|
|
.Em prefix
|
|
|
|
table, so
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b c
|
|
|
|
creates a new window).
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Em root
|
|
|
|
table is used for keys pressed without the prefix key: binding
|
|
|
|
.Ql c
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
in the
|
|
|
|
.Em root
|
|
|
|
table (not recommended) means a plain
|
|
|
|
.Ql c
|
|
|
|
will create a new window.
|
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
|
|
|
is an alias
|
|
|
|
for
|
|
|
|
.Fl T Ar root .
|
|
|
|
Keys may also be bound in custom key tables and the
|
|
|
|
.Ic switch-client
|
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
command used to switch to them from a key binding.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl r
|
|
|
|
flag indicates this key may repeat, see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic repeat-time
|
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
To view the default bindings and possible commands, see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic list-keys
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic list-keys
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl T Ar key-table
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lsk )
|
|
|
|
List all key bindings.
|
|
|
|
Without
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
all key tables are printed.
|
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
only
|
|
|
|
.Ar key-table .
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic send-keys
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl lMRX
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl N Ar repeat-count
|
2009-08-20 11:37:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2008-06-02 21:36:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar key Ar ...
|
2008-06-01 20:20:25 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-01-07 18:54:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic send )
|
2008-06-01 20:20:25 +00:00
|
|
|
Send a key or keys to a window.
|
|
|
|
Each argument
|
|
|
|
.Ar key
|
|
|
|
is the name of the key (such as
|
2008-06-25 20:33:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql C-a
|
2008-06-01 20:20:25 +00:00
|
|
|
or
|
2017-01-10 10:08:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql NPage )
|
|
|
|
to send; if the string is not recognised as a key, it is sent as a series of
|
2008-06-01 20:20:25 +00:00
|
|
|
characters.
|
2012-02-02 02:01:18 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl l
|
|
|
|
flag disables key name lookup and sends the keys literally.
|
2008-06-05 15:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
All arguments are sent sequentially from first to last.
|
2012-01-21 19:31:59 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl R
|
|
|
|
flag causes the terminal state to be reset.
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl M
|
|
|
|
passes through a mouse event (only valid if bound to a mouse key binding, see
|
2015-04-19 22:10:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx MOUSE SUPPORT ) .
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl X
|
|
|
|
is used to send a command into copy mode - see
|
|
|
|
the
|
|
|
|
.Sx WINDOWS AND PANES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
|
|
|
.Fl N
|
2016-11-29 12:54:46 +00:00
|
|
|
specifies a repeat count.
|
2012-01-21 19:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic send-prefix
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl 2
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Send the prefix key, or with
|
|
|
|
.Fl 2
|
|
|
|
the secondary prefix key, to a window as if it was pressed.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic unbind-key
|
2016-10-12 15:26:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl an
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl T Ar key-table
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar key
|
2008-06-30 05:34:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic unbind )
|
|
|
|
Unbind the command bound to
|
|
|
|
.Ar key .
|
2017-01-25 14:24:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
2017-01-25 14:24:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
2015-04-20 15:34:56 +00:00
|
|
|
are the same as for
|
|
|
|
.Ic bind-key .
|
2010-12-06 21:51:02 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
is present, all key bindings are removed.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Sh OPTIONS
|
|
|
|
The appearance and behaviour of
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
may be modified by changing the value of various options.
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
There are four types of option:
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em server options ,
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em session options
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em window options
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em pane options .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
server has a set of global options which do not apply to any particular
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
window or session or pane.
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
These are altered with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-option
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
command, or displayed with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic show-options
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
In addition, each individual session may have a set of session options, and
|
|
|
|
there is a separate set of global session options.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Sessions which do not have a particular option configured inherit the value
|
|
|
|
from the global session options.
|
|
|
|
Session options are set or unset with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-option
|
|
|
|
command and may be listed with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic show-options
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
The available server and session options are listed under the
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic set-option
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
Similarly, a set of window options is attached to each window and a set of pane
|
|
|
|
options to each pane.
|
|
|
|
Pane options inherit from window options.
|
|
|
|
This means any pane option may be set as a window option to apply the option to
|
|
|
|
all panes in the window without the option set, for example these commands will
|
|
|
|
set the background colour to red for all panes except pane 0:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
set -w window-style bg=red
|
|
|
|
set -pt:.0 window-style bg=blue
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
There is also a set of global window options from which any unset window or
|
|
|
|
pane options are inherited.
|
|
|
|
Window and pane options are altered with
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-option
|
|
|
|
.Fl w
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
|
|
|
commands and displayed with
|
|
|
|
.Ic show-option
|
|
|
|
.Fl w
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl p .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2013-02-13 09:54:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
also supports user options which are prefixed with a
|
|
|
|
.Ql \&@ .
|
2013-03-25 11:49:54 +00:00
|
|
|
User options may have any name, so long as they are prefixed with
|
|
|
|
.Ql \&@ ,
|
2013-02-13 09:54:24 +00:00
|
|
|
and be set to any string.
|
2015-04-19 21:05:27 +00:00
|
|
|
For example:
|
2013-02-13 09:54:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ tmux setw -q @foo "abc123"
|
|
|
|
$ tmux showw -v @foo
|
|
|
|
abc123
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Commands which set options are as follows:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
2007-11-12 16:40:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic set-option
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl aFgopqsuw
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar option Ar value
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2007-11-09 16:08:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic set )
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
Set a pane option with
|
|
|
|
.Fl p ,
|
|
|
|
a window option with
|
|
|
|
.Fl w ,
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
a server option with
|
|
|
|
.Fl s ,
|
|
|
|
otherwise a session option.
|
2019-04-18 12:22:07 +00:00
|
|
|
If the option is not a user option,
|
|
|
|
.Fl w
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
or
|
2019-04-18 12:22:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
may be unnecessary -
|
2019-04-18 12:22:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
will infer the type from the option name, assuming
|
|
|
|
.Fl w
|
|
|
|
for pane options.
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl g
|
2015-06-04 14:29:33 +00:00
|
|
|
is given, the global session or window option is set.
|
2019-04-18 12:22:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-05-10 13:05:41 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
expands formats in the option value.
|
2009-01-15 21:24:03 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl u
|
|
|
|
flag unsets an option, so a session inherits the option from the global
|
2015-06-04 14:29:33 +00:00
|
|
|
options (or with
|
|
|
|
.Fl g ,
|
|
|
|
restores a global option to the default).
|
2013-02-23 23:21:22 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl o
|
2015-07-27 08:45:45 +00:00
|
|
|
flag prevents setting an option that is already set and the
|
2012-03-18 02:09:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl q
|
2015-07-27 08:45:45 +00:00
|
|
|
flag suppresses errors about unknown or ambiguous options.
|
2012-03-18 02:09:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl a ,
|
|
|
|
and if the option expects a string or a style,
|
|
|
|
.Ar value
|
|
|
|
is appended to the existing setting.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
set -g status-left "foo"
|
|
|
|
set -ag status-left "bar"
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Will result in
|
|
|
|
.Ql foobar .
|
|
|
|
And:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
set -g status-style "bg=red"
|
|
|
|
set -ag status-style "fg=blue"
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Will result in a red background
|
|
|
|
.Em and
|
|
|
|
blue foreground.
|
|
|
|
Without
|
|
|
|
.Fl a ,
|
|
|
|
the result would be the default background and a blue foreground.
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic show-options
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl AgHpqsvw
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Ar option
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic show )
|
|
|
|
Show the pane options (or a single option if
|
|
|
|
.Ar option
|
|
|
|
is provided) with
|
|
|
|
.Fl p ,
|
|
|
|
the window options with
|
|
|
|
.Fl w ,
|
|
|
|
the server options with
|
|
|
|
.Fl s ,
|
|
|
|
otherwise the session options.
|
|
|
|
If the option is not a user option,
|
|
|
|
.Fl w
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
may be unnecessary -
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
will infer the type from the option name, assuming
|
|
|
|
.Fl w
|
|
|
|
for pane options.
|
|
|
|
Global session or window options are listed if
|
|
|
|
.Fl g
|
|
|
|
is used.
|
|
|
|
.Fl v
|
|
|
|
shows only the option value, not the name.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl q
|
|
|
|
is set, no error will be returned if
|
|
|
|
.Ar option
|
|
|
|
is unset.
|
|
|
|
.Fl H
|
|
|
|
includes hooks (omitted by default).
|
|
|
|
.Fl A
|
|
|
|
includes options inherited from a parent set of options, such options are
|
|
|
|
marked with an asterisk.
|
2012-02-15 19:30:17 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar value
|
|
|
|
depends on the option and may be a number, a string, or a flag (on, off, or
|
|
|
|
omitted to toggle).
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2012-02-15 19:30:17 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
Available server options are:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
2010-12-30 22:39:49 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic buffer-limit Ar number
|
|
|
|
Set the number of buffers; as new buffers are added to the top of the stack,
|
|
|
|
old ones are removed from the bottom if necessary to maintain this maximum
|
|
|
|
length.
|
2017-01-24 19:53:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic command-alias[]
|
|
|
|
.Ar name=value
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
This is an array of custom aliases for commands.
|
|
|
|
If an unknown command matches
|
|
|
|
.Ar name ,
|
|
|
|
it is replaced with
|
|
|
|
.Ar value .
|
|
|
|
For example, after:
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-06-29 22:02:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Dl set -s command-alias[100] zoom='resize-pane -Z'
|
2017-01-24 19:53:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Using:
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Dl zoom -t:.1
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Is equivalent to:
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Dl resize-pane -Z -t:.1
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Note that aliases are expanded when a command is parsed rather than when it is
|
|
|
|
executed, so binding an alias with
|
|
|
|
.Ic bind-key
|
|
|
|
will bind the expanded form.
|
2015-04-29 15:59:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic default-terminal Ar terminal
|
|
|
|
Set the default terminal for new windows created in this session - the
|
|
|
|
default value of the
|
|
|
|
.Ev TERM
|
|
|
|
environment variable.
|
|
|
|
For
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
to work correctly, this
|
|
|
|
.Em must
|
|
|
|
be set to
|
|
|
|
.Ql screen ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql tmux
|
|
|
|
or a derivative of them.
|
2011-08-04 17:01:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic escape-time Ar time
|
|
|
|
Set the time in milliseconds for which
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
waits after an escape is input to determine if it is part of a function or meta
|
|
|
|
key sequences.
|
|
|
|
The default is 500 milliseconds.
|
2018-02-22 10:54:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic exit-empty
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
If enabled (the default), the server will exit when there are no active
|
|
|
|
sessions.
|
2011-08-04 17:01:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic exit-unattached
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
If enabled, the server will exit when there are no attached clients.
|
2013-06-23 13:10:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic focus-events
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
When enabled, focus events are requested from the terminal if supported and
|
|
|
|
passed through to applications running in
|
|
|
|
.Nm .
|
|
|
|
Attached clients should be detached and attached again after changing this
|
|
|
|
option.
|
2015-07-20 15:50:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic history-file Ar path
|
|
|
|
If not empty, a file to which
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
will write command prompt history on exit and load it from on start.
|
2014-03-07 15:37:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic message-limit Ar number
|
|
|
|
Set the number of error or information messages to save in the message log for
|
|
|
|
each client.
|
|
|
|
The default is 100.
|
2011-05-22 16:23:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic set-clipboard
|
2017-06-03 17:43:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | external | off
|
2011-05-22 16:23:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Attempt to set the terminal clipboard content using the
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1
|
2017-06-09 09:21:24 +00:00
|
|
|
escape sequence, if there is an
|
2011-05-22 16:23:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em \&Ms
|
|
|
|
entry in the
|
|
|
|
.Xr terminfo 5
|
2017-06-09 09:21:24 +00:00
|
|
|
description (see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx TERMINFO EXTENSIONS
|
|
|
|
section).
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-06-03 17:43:01 +00:00
|
|
|
If set to
|
|
|
|
.Ic on ,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
will both accept the escape sequence to create a buffer and attempt to set
|
|
|
|
the terminal clipboard.
|
|
|
|
If set to
|
|
|
|
.Ic external ,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
will attempt to set the terminal clipboard but ignore attempts
|
|
|
|
by applications to set
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
buffers.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ic off ,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
will neither accept the clipboard escape sequence nor attempt to set the
|
|
|
|
clipboard.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2011-05-22 16:23:07 +00:00
|
|
|
Note that this feature needs to be enabled in
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1
|
|
|
|
by setting the resource:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
disallowedWindowOps: 20,21,SetXprop
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Or changing this property from the
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1
|
|
|
|
interactive menu when required.
|
2017-01-24 20:05:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic terminal-overrides[] Ar string
|
|
|
|
Allow terminal descriptions read using
|
|
|
|
.Xr terminfo 5
|
2017-01-25 14:24:54 +00:00
|
|
|
to be overridden.
|
2017-01-24 20:05:15 +00:00
|
|
|
Each entry is a colon-separated string made up of a terminal type pattern
|
|
|
|
(matched using
|
2014-02-23 00:53:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr fnmatch 3 )
|
|
|
|
and a set of
|
|
|
|
.Em name=value
|
|
|
|
entries.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
For example, to set the
|
|
|
|
.Ql clear
|
|
|
|
.Xr terminfo 5
|
|
|
|
entry to
|
|
|
|
.Ql \ee[H\ee[2J
|
2017-01-24 20:05:15 +00:00
|
|
|
for all terminal types matching
|
|
|
|
.Ql rxvt* :
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Dl "rxvt*:clear=\ee[H\ee[2J"
|
2014-02-23 00:53:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The terminal entry value is passed through
|
|
|
|
.Xr strunvis 3
|
|
|
|
before interpretation.
|
2009-12-10 16:59:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-12-04 22:11:23 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-07-08 17:57:07 +00:00
|
|
|
Available session options are:
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic activity-action
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic any | none | current | other
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Set action on window activity when
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-activity
|
|
|
|
is on.
|
|
|
|
.Ic any
|
|
|
|
means activity in any window linked to a session causes a bell or message
|
|
|
|
(depending on
|
|
|
|
.Ic visual-activity )
|
|
|
|
in the current window of that session,
|
|
|
|
.Ic none
|
|
|
|
means all activity is ignored (equivalent to
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-activity
|
|
|
|
being off),
|
|
|
|
.Ic current
|
|
|
|
means only activity in windows other than the current window are ignored and
|
|
|
|
.Ic other
|
|
|
|
means activity in the current window is ignored but not those in other windows.
|
2013-01-15 22:55:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic assume-paste-time Ar milliseconds
|
|
|
|
If keys are entered faster than one in
|
|
|
|
.Ar milliseconds ,
|
|
|
|
they are assumed to have been pasted rather than typed and
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
key bindings are not processed.
|
|
|
|
The default is one millisecond and zero disables.
|
2009-08-16 19:16:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic base-index Ar index
|
|
|
|
Set the base index from which an unused index should be searched when a new
|
|
|
|
window is created.
|
|
|
|
The default is zero.
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic bell-action
|
2015-05-12 15:27:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic any | none | current | other
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2017-08-17 08:37:38 +00:00
|
|
|
Set action on a bell in a window when
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-bell
|
|
|
|
is on.
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
The values are the same as those for
|
|
|
|
.Ic activity-action .
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic default-command Ar shell-command
|
2009-01-15 21:24:03 +00:00
|
|
|
Set the command used for new windows (if not specified when the window is
|
2008-06-11 06:19:56 +00:00
|
|
|
created) to
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command ,
|
2009-09-02 01:02:44 +00:00
|
|
|
which may be any
|
|
|
|
.Xr sh 1
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2009-07-01 19:42:55 +00:00
|
|
|
The default is an empty string, which instructs
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2009-09-02 01:02:44 +00:00
|
|
|
to create a login shell using the value of the
|
|
|
|
.Ic default-shell
|
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic default-shell Ar path
|
|
|
|
Specify the default shell.
|
|
|
|
This is used as the login shell for new windows when the
|
|
|
|
.Ic default-command
|
|
|
|
option is set to empty, and must be the full path of the executable.
|
|
|
|
When started
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
tries to set a default value from the first suitable of the
|
2009-07-01 19:42:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ev SHELL
|
2009-09-02 01:02:44 +00:00
|
|
|
environment variable, the shell returned by
|
|
|
|
.Xr getpwuid 3 ,
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Pa /bin/sh .
|
|
|
|
This option should be configured when
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
is used as a login shell.
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic default-size Ar XxY
|
2019-05-02 20:12:40 +00:00
|
|
|
Set the default size of new windows when the
|
2019-05-03 16:12:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic window-size
|
2019-05-02 20:12:40 +00:00
|
|
|
option is set to manual or when a session is created with
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-session
|
|
|
|
.Fl d .
|
|
|
|
The value is the width and height separated by an
|
|
|
|
.Ql x
|
|
|
|
character.
|
|
|
|
The default is 80x24.
|
2011-01-21 23:45:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic destroy-unattached
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2010-10-09 14:29:32 +00:00
|
|
|
If enabled and the session is no longer attached to any clients, it is
|
|
|
|
destroyed.
|
2011-01-21 23:45:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic detach-on-destroy
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2010-10-09 14:25:40 +00:00
|
|
|
If on (the default), the client is detached when the session it is attached to
|
|
|
|
is destroyed.
|
|
|
|
If off, the client is switched to the most recently active of the remaining
|
|
|
|
sessions.
|
2010-02-05 01:31:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic display-panes-active-colour Ar colour
|
|
|
|
Set the colour used by the
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes
|
|
|
|
command to show the indicator for the active pane.
|
2009-08-31 22:30:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic display-panes-colour Ar colour
|
2010-02-05 01:31:06 +00:00
|
|
|
Set the colour used by the
|
2009-08-31 22:30:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes
|
2010-02-05 01:31:06 +00:00
|
|
|
command to show the indicators for inactive panes.
|
2009-08-31 22:30:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic display-panes-time Ar time
|
|
|
|
Set the time in milliseconds for which the indicators shown by the
|
|
|
|
.Ic display-panes
|
|
|
|
command appear.
|
2009-07-12 17:04:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic display-time Ar time
|
2009-08-31 22:30:15 +00:00
|
|
|
Set the amount of time for which status line messages and other on-screen
|
|
|
|
indicators are displayed.
|
2015-11-22 18:28:01 +00:00
|
|
|
If set to 0, messages and indicators are displayed until a key is pressed.
|
2009-07-12 17:04:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar time
|
|
|
|
is in milliseconds.
|
2007-11-24 14:21:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic history-limit Ar lines
|
|
|
|
Set the maximum number of lines held in window history.
|
|
|
|
This setting applies only to new windows - existing window histories are not
|
|
|
|
resized and retain the limit at the point they were created.
|
2015-12-12 18:32:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic key-table Ar key-table
|
|
|
|
Set the default key table to
|
|
|
|
.Ar key-table
|
|
|
|
instead of
|
|
|
|
.Em root .
|
2009-01-12 21:23:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic lock-after-time Ar number
|
2009-10-11 23:30:28 +00:00
|
|
|
Lock the session (like the
|
|
|
|
.Ic lock-session
|
2009-09-23 15:00:09 +00:00
|
|
|
command) after
|
2009-01-12 21:23:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar number
|
2015-08-28 12:31:55 +00:00
|
|
|
seconds of inactivity.
|
2009-10-11 23:30:28 +00:00
|
|
|
The default is not to lock (set to 0).
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic lock-command Ar shell-command
|
2009-09-23 15:00:09 +00:00
|
|
|
Command to run when locking each client.
|
|
|
|
The default is to run
|
|
|
|
.Xr lock 1
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl np .
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic message-command-style Ar style
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
Set status line message command style.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic message-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set status line message style.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic mouse
|
2009-10-11 23:46:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
If on,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
captures the mouse and allows mouse events to be bound as key bindings.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Sx MOUSE SUPPORT
|
|
|
|
section for details.
|
2012-01-21 19:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic prefix Ar key
|
|
|
|
Set the key accepted as a prefix key.
|
2015-12-12 18:19:00 +00:00
|
|
|
In addition to the standard keys described under
|
|
|
|
.Sx KEY BINDINGS ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic prefix
|
|
|
|
can be set to the special key
|
|
|
|
.Ql None
|
|
|
|
to set no prefix.
|
2012-01-21 19:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic prefix2 Ar key
|
|
|
|
Set a secondary key accepted as a prefix key.
|
2015-12-12 18:19:00 +00:00
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ic prefix ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic prefix2
|
|
|
|
can be set to
|
|
|
|
.Ql None .
|
2012-05-03 17:51:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic renumber-windows
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
If on, when a window is closed in a session, automatically renumber the other
|
|
|
|
windows in numerical order.
|
|
|
|
This respects the
|
|
|
|
.Ic base-index
|
|
|
|
option if it has been set.
|
|
|
|
If off, do not renumber the windows.
|
2009-07-12 17:04:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic repeat-time Ar time
|
2009-01-16 22:52:31 +00:00
|
|
|
Allow multiple commands to be entered without pressing the prefix-key again
|
|
|
|
in the specified
|
2009-07-12 17:04:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar time
|
2009-02-08 18:41:03 +00:00
|
|
|
milliseconds (the default is 500).
|
2009-04-20 19:11:31 +00:00
|
|
|
Whether a key repeats may be set when it is bound using the
|
|
|
|
.Fl r
|
|
|
|
flag to
|
|
|
|
.Ic bind-key .
|
2009-07-30 20:45:20 +00:00
|
|
|
Repeat is enabled for the default keys bound to the
|
|
|
|
.Ic resize-pane
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic set-titles
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
Attempt to set the client terminal title using the
|
|
|
|
.Em tsl
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Em fsl
|
|
|
|
.Xr terminfo 5
|
|
|
|
entries if they exist.
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2015-07-20 10:34:11 +00:00
|
|
|
automatically sets these to the \ee]0;...\e007 sequence if
|
|
|
|
the terminal appears to be
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1 .
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
This option is off by default.
|
2009-09-19 18:53:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic set-titles-string Ar string
|
|
|
|
String used to set the window title if
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-titles
|
|
|
|
is on.
|
2015-03-11 08:17:37 +00:00
|
|
|
Formats are expanded, see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic silence-action
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic any | none | current | other
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Set action on window silence when
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-silence
|
|
|
|
is on.
|
|
|
|
The values are the same as those for
|
|
|
|
.Ic activity-action .
|
2008-06-06 20:07:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic status
|
2019-03-18 20:53:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic off | on | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Show or hide the status line or specify its size.
|
|
|
|
Using
|
|
|
|
.Ic on
|
|
|
|
gives a status line one row in height;
|
|
|
|
.Ic 2 ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic 3 ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic 4
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic 5
|
|
|
|
more rows.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic status-format[] Ar format
|
|
|
|
Specify the format to be used for each line of the status line.
|
|
|
|
The default builds the top status line from the various individual status
|
|
|
|
options below.
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-interval Ar interval
|
2017-02-15 08:47:55 +00:00
|
|
|
Update the status line every
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar interval
|
|
|
|
seconds.
|
|
|
|
By default, updates will occur every 15 seconds.
|
2009-02-10 00:09:44 +00:00
|
|
|
A setting of zero disables redrawing at interval.
|
2009-07-20 16:01:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic status-justify
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic left | centre | right
|
2009-07-20 16:01:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Set the position of the window list component of the status line: left, centre
|
|
|
|
or right justified.
|
2009-04-21 16:30:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic status-keys
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic vi | emacs
|
2009-04-21 16:30:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
Use vi or emacs-style
|
2009-04-21 16:30:53 +00:00
|
|
|
key bindings in the status line, for example at the command prompt.
|
2010-12-06 21:59:42 +00:00
|
|
|
The default is emacs, unless the
|
|
|
|
.Ev VISUAL
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ev EDITOR
|
|
|
|
environment variables are set and contain the string
|
|
|
|
.Ql vi .
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-left Ar string
|
|
|
|
Display
|
|
|
|
.Ar string
|
2017-02-15 08:47:55 +00:00
|
|
|
(by default the session name) to the left of the status line.
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar string
|
|
|
|
will be passed through
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr strftime 3 .
|
|
|
|
Also see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
sections.
|
2009-01-07 23:07:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2012-01-20 21:19:20 +00:00
|
|
|
For details on how the names and titles can be set see the
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx "NAMES AND TITLES"
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2009-10-15 01:31:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-09-07 23:37:48 +00:00
|
|
|
Examples are:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
#(sysctl vm.loadavg)
|
|
|
|
#[fg=yellow,bold]#(apm -l)%%#[default] [#S]
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-11-05 23:15:11 +00:00
|
|
|
The default is
|
|
|
|
.Ql "[#S] " .
|
2009-01-07 23:07:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-left-length Ar length
|
|
|
|
Set the maximum
|
|
|
|
.Ar length
|
2017-02-15 08:47:55 +00:00
|
|
|
of the left component of the status line.
|
2009-01-07 23:07:42 +00:00
|
|
|
The default is 10.
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-left-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set the style of the left part of the status line.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2012-01-29 12:57:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic status-position
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic top | bottom
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Set the position of the status line.
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-right Ar string
|
|
|
|
Display
|
|
|
|
.Ar string
|
2017-02-15 08:47:55 +00:00
|
|
|
to the right of the status line.
|
2017-09-02 17:51:54 +00:00
|
|
|
By default, the current pane title in double quotes, the date and the time
|
2010-02-18 12:33:52 +00:00
|
|
|
are shown.
|
2008-06-19 22:14:12 +00:00
|
|
|
As with
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-left ,
|
|
|
|
.Ar string
|
|
|
|
will be passed to
|
2015-11-12 12:36:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr strftime 3
|
|
|
|
and character pairs are replaced.
|
2009-01-07 23:07:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-right-length Ar length
|
|
|
|
Set the maximum
|
|
|
|
.Ar length
|
2017-02-15 08:47:55 +00:00
|
|
|
of the right component of the status line.
|
2009-01-07 23:07:42 +00:00
|
|
|
The default is 40.
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-right-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set the style of the right part of the status line.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic status-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set status line style.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2017-01-24 20:15:32 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic update-environment[] Ar variable
|
|
|
|
Set list of environment variables to be copied into the session environment
|
|
|
|
when a new session is created or an existing session is attached.
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
Any variables that do not exist in the source environment are set to be
|
|
|
|
removed from the session environment (as if
|
|
|
|
.Fl r
|
|
|
|
was given to the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-environment
|
|
|
|
command).
|
2017-06-23 15:36:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic user-keys[] Ar key
|
|
|
|
Set list of user-defined key escape sequences.
|
|
|
|
Each item is associated with a key named
|
2017-06-28 06:45:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql User0 ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql User1 ,
|
2017-06-23 15:36:52 +00:00
|
|
|
and so on.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2017-08-19 20:40:16 +00:00
|
|
|
set -s user-keys[0] "\ee[5;30012~"
|
2017-06-23 15:36:52 +00:00
|
|
|
bind User0 resize-pane -L 3
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2009-07-19 14:35:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic visual-activity
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off | both
|
2009-07-19 14:35:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
If on, display a message instead of sending a bell when activity occurs in a
|
|
|
|
window for which the
|
2009-07-19 14:35:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-activity
|
|
|
|
window option is enabled.
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
If set to both, a bell and a message are produced.
|
2009-07-19 14:35:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic visual-bell
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off | both
|
2009-07-19 14:35:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2017-08-17 08:37:38 +00:00
|
|
|
If on, a message is shown on a bell in a window for which the
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-bell
|
|
|
|
window option is enabled instead of it being passed through to the
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
terminal (which normally makes a sound).
|
|
|
|
If set to both, a bell and a message are produced.
|
2009-07-19 14:35:56 +00:00
|
|
|
Also see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic bell-action
|
|
|
|
option.
|
2010-12-06 22:52:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic visual-silence
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off | both
|
2010-12-06 22:52:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-silence
|
2017-07-26 16:14:08 +00:00
|
|
|
is enabled, prints a message after the interval has expired on a given window
|
|
|
|
instead of sending a bell.
|
|
|
|
If set to both, a bell and a message are produced.
|
2011-11-25 13:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic word-separators Ar string
|
|
|
|
Sets the session's conception of what characters are considered word
|
|
|
|
separators, for the purposes of the next and previous word commands in
|
|
|
|
copy mode.
|
|
|
|
The default is
|
|
|
|
.Ql \ -_@ .
|
2007-11-12 16:09:08 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-01-14 18:47:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
Available window options are:
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact
|
2008-06-17 06:18:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic aggressive-resize
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
2008-11-17 17:41:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2008-06-17 06:18:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Aggressively resize the chosen window.
|
|
|
|
This means that
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
will resize the window to the size of the smallest or largest session
|
|
|
|
(see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic window-size
|
|
|
|
option) for which it is the current window, rather than the session to
|
|
|
|
which it is attached.
|
|
|
|
The window may resize when the current window is changed on another
|
|
|
|
session; this option is good for full-screen programs which support
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Dv SIGWINCH
|
|
|
|
and poor for interactive programs such as shells.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-02-07 08:35:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic automatic-rename
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
2009-02-07 08:35:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Control automatic window renaming.
|
|
|
|
When this setting is enabled,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2013-08-19 21:16:11 +00:00
|
|
|
will rename the window automatically using the format specified by
|
|
|
|
.Ic automatic-rename-format .
|
2009-02-07 08:35:26 +00:00
|
|
|
This flag is automatically disabled for an individual window when a name
|
|
|
|
is specified at creation with
|
2010-10-24 00:29:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
or
|
2009-02-07 08:35:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic new-session ,
|
|
|
|
or later with
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic rename-window ,
|
|
|
|
or with a terminal escape sequence.
|
2009-02-07 08:35:26 +00:00
|
|
|
It may be switched off globally with:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
set-option -wg automatic-rename off
|
2009-02-07 08:35:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2013-08-19 21:16:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic automatic-rename-format Ar format
|
|
|
|
The format (see
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS )
|
|
|
|
used when the
|
|
|
|
.Ic automatic-rename
|
|
|
|
option is enabled.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-01-12 21:23:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic clock-mode-colour Ar colour
|
|
|
|
Set clock colour.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-01-12 21:23:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic clock-mode-style
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic 12 | 24
|
2009-01-12 21:23:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Set clock hour format.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic main-pane-height Ar height
|
2010-12-27 21:13:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic main-pane-width Ar width
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
Set the width or height of the main (left or top) pane in the
|
|
|
|
.Ic main-horizontal
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic main-vertical
|
|
|
|
layouts.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-01-07 18:54:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic mode-keys
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic vi | emacs
|
2009-01-07 18:54:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2016-10-12 14:50:14 +00:00
|
|
|
Use vi or emacs-style key bindings in copy mode.
|
|
|
|
The default is emacs, unless
|
2010-12-06 21:59:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ev VISUAL
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ev EDITOR
|
|
|
|
contains
|
|
|
|
.Ql vi .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic mode-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set window modes style.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-01-07 18:54:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic monitor-activity
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
2009-01-07 18:54:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Monitor for activity in the window.
|
|
|
|
Windows with activity are highlighted in the status line.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-08-17 08:37:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic monitor-bell
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Monitor for a bell in the window.
|
|
|
|
Windows with a bell are highlighted in the status line.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-12-06 22:52:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic monitor-silence
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic interval
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Monitor for silence (no activity) in the window within
|
|
|
|
.Ic interval
|
|
|
|
seconds.
|
|
|
|
Windows that have been silent for the interval are highlighted in the
|
|
|
|
status line.
|
|
|
|
An interval of zero disables the monitoring.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2010-12-22 15:23:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic other-pane-height Ar height
|
|
|
|
Set the height of the other panes (not the main pane) in the
|
|
|
|
.Ic main-horizontal
|
|
|
|
layout.
|
|
|
|
If this option is set to 0 (the default), it will have no effect.
|
|
|
|
If both the
|
|
|
|
.Ic main-pane-height
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic other-pane-height
|
|
|
|
options are set, the main pane will grow taller to make the other panes the
|
|
|
|
specified height, but will never shrink to do so.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.It Ic other-pane-width Ar width
|
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ic other-pane-height ,
|
|
|
|
but set the width of other panes in the
|
|
|
|
.Ic main-vertical
|
|
|
|
layout.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-02-06 15:09:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic pane-active-border-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set the pane border style for the currently active pane.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2015-02-06 15:09:34 +00:00
|
|
|
Attributes are ignored.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2011-08-25 21:13:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic pane-base-index Ar index
|
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ic base-index ,
|
|
|
|
but set the starting index for pane numbers.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2016-04-29 15:00:48 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic pane-border-format Ar format
|
|
|
|
Set the text shown in pane border status lines.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic pane-border-status
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic off | top | bottom
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Turn pane border status lines off or set their position.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-02-06 15:09:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic pane-border-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set the pane border style for panes aside from the active pane.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2015-02-06 15:09:34 +00:00
|
|
|
Attributes are ignored.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-10-09 13:07:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic synchronize-panes
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2010-04-05 05:11:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Duplicate input to any pane to all other panes in the same window (only
|
|
|
|
for panes that are not in any special mode).
|
2010-01-19 00:46:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-activity-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set status line style for windows with an activity alert.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-bell-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set status line style for windows with a bell alert.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-11-19 22:35:10 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-current-format Ar string
|
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-status-format ,
|
|
|
|
but is the format used when the window is the current window.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-current-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set status line style for the currently active window.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2011-08-04 17:01:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-format Ar string
|
|
|
|
Set the format in which the window is displayed in the status line window list.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
sections.
|
2011-08-04 17:01:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-last-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set status line style for the last active window.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2012-04-24 16:20:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-separator Ar string
|
|
|
|
Sets the separator drawn between windows in the status line.
|
|
|
|
The default is a single space character.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic window-status-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set status line style for a single window.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-03-22 09:33:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic window-size
|
Support for windows larger than the client.
This adds two new options, window-size and default-size, and a new
command, resize-window.
The force-width and force-height options, and the session_width and
session_height formats have been removed.
The new window-size option tells tmux how to work out the size of
windows: largest means it picks the size of the largest session,
smallest the smallest session (similar to the old behaviour) and
manual means that it does not automatically resize
windows. aggressive-resize modifies the choice of session for largest
and smallest as it did before.
If a window is in a session attached to a client that is too small,
only part of the window is shown. tmux attempts to keep the cursor
visible, so the part of the window displayed is changed as the cursor
moves (with a small delay, to try and avoid excess redrawing when
applications redraw status lines or similar that are not currently
visible).
Drawing windows which are larger than the client is not as efficient
as those which fit, particularly when the cursor moves, so it is
recommended to avoid using this on slow machines or networks (set
window-size to smallest or manual).
The resize-window command can be used to resize a window manually. If
it is used, the window-size option is automatically set to manual for
the window (undo this with "setw -u window-size"). resize-window works
in a similar way to resize-pane (-U -D -L -R -x -y flags) but also has
-a and -A flags. -a sets the window to the size of the smallest client
(what it would be if window-size was smallest) and -A the largest.
For the same behaviour as force-width or force-height, use
resize-width -x or -y.
If the global window-size option is set to manual, the default-size
option is used for new windows. If -x or -y is used with new-session,
that sets the default-size option for the new session.
The maximum size of a window is 10000x10000. But expect applications
to complain and higher memory use if you make a window that big. The
minimum size is the size required for the current layout including
borders.
This change allows some code improvements, most notably that since
windows can now never be cropped, that code can be removed from the
layout code, and since panes can now never be outside the size of the
window, window_pane_visible can be removed.
2018-08-20 14:22:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar largest | Ar smallest | Ar manual
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Configure how
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
determines the window size.
|
|
|
|
If set to
|
|
|
|
.Ar largest ,
|
|
|
|
the size of the largest attached session is used; if
|
|
|
|
.Ar smallest ,
|
|
|
|
the size of the smallest.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar manual ,
|
|
|
|
the size of a new window is set from the
|
|
|
|
.Ic default-size
|
|
|
|
option and windows are resized automatically.
|
|
|
|
See also the
|
|
|
|
.Ic resize-window
|
|
|
|
command and the
|
|
|
|
.Ic aggressive-resize
|
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2016-10-18 19:25:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic wrap-search
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
If this option is set, searches will wrap around the end of the pane contents.
|
|
|
|
The default is on.
|
2016-10-21 13:51:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-04-21 16:30:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic xterm-keys
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
2009-01-17 17:16:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
If this option is set,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
will generate
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1 -style
|
|
|
|
function key sequences; these have a number included to indicate modifiers such
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
as Shift, Alt or Ctrl.
|
2008-06-17 06:18:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Available pane options are:
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact
|
2019-06-20 13:40:22 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic allow-rename
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Allow programs in the pane to change the window name using a terminal escape
|
|
|
|
sequence (\eek...\ee\e\e).
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic alternate-screen
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
This option configures whether programs running inside the pane may use the
|
|
|
|
terminal alternate screen feature, which allows the
|
|
|
|
.Em smcup
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Em rmcup
|
|
|
|
.Xr terminfo 5
|
|
|
|
capabilities.
|
|
|
|
The alternate screen feature preserves the contents of the window when an
|
|
|
|
interactive application starts and restores it on exit, so that any output
|
|
|
|
visible before the application starts reappears unchanged after it exits.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic remain-on-exit
|
|
|
|
.Op Ic on | off
|
2008-06-17 06:22:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2019-06-20 11:59:59 +00:00
|
|
|
A pane with this flag set is not destroyed when the program running in it
|
|
|
|
exits.
|
|
|
|
The pane may be reactivated with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic respawn-pane
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.It Ic window-active-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set the pane style when it is the active pane.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.It Ic window-style Ar style
|
|
|
|
Set the pane style.
|
|
|
|
For how to specify
|
|
|
|
.Ar style ,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2015-12-08 01:10:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh HOOKS
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
allows commands to run on various triggers, called
|
|
|
|
.Em hooks .
|
2016-10-13 22:48:51 +00:00
|
|
|
Most
|
2016-04-29 14:05:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2016-10-13 22:48:51 +00:00
|
|
|
commands have an
|
2016-04-29 14:05:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em after
|
|
|
|
hook and there are a number of hooks not associated with commands.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-04-26 11:38:51 +00:00
|
|
|
Hooks are stored as array options, members of the array are executed in
|
|
|
|
order when the hook is triggered.
|
|
|
|
Hooks may be configured with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-hook
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-option
|
|
|
|
commands and displayed with
|
|
|
|
.Ic show-hooks
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic show-options
|
|
|
|
.Fl H .
|
|
|
|
The following two commands are equivalent:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent.
|
|
|
|
set-hook -g pane-mode-changed[42] 'set -g status-left-style bg=red'
|
|
|
|
set-option -g pane-mode-changed[42] 'set -g status-left-style bg=red'
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Setting a hook without specifying an array index clears the hook and sets the
|
|
|
|
first member of the array.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2016-10-13 22:48:51 +00:00
|
|
|
A command's after
|
|
|
|
hook is run after it completes, except when the command is run as part of a hook
|
2016-04-29 14:05:24 +00:00
|
|
|
itself.
|
2016-10-13 22:48:51 +00:00
|
|
|
They are named with an
|
2016-04-29 14:05:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql after-
|
|
|
|
prefix.
|
|
|
|
For example, the following command adds a hook to select the even-vertical
|
|
|
|
layout after every
|
|
|
|
.Ic split-window :
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2019-04-26 11:38:51 +00:00
|
|
|
set-hook -g after-split-window "selectl even-vertical"
|
2016-04-29 14:05:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-10-25 15:20:10 +00:00
|
|
|
All the notifications listed in the
|
|
|
|
.Sx CONTROL MODE
|
|
|
|
section are hooks (without any arguments), except
|
|
|
|
.Ic %exit .
|
|
|
|
The following additional hooks are available:
|
2017-06-09 09:21:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width "XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX"
|
2016-01-16 00:36:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It alert-activity
|
|
|
|
Run when a window has activity.
|
|
|
|
See
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-activity .
|
|
|
|
.It alert-bell
|
|
|
|
Run when a window has received a bell.
|
2017-08-17 08:37:38 +00:00
|
|
|
See
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-bell .
|
2016-01-16 00:36:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It alert-silence
|
|
|
|
Run when a window has been silent.
|
|
|
|
See
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-silence .
|
2015-12-08 01:10:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.It client-attached
|
|
|
|
Run when a client is attached.
|
|
|
|
.It client-detached
|
|
|
|
Run when a client is detached
|
|
|
|
.It client-resized
|
|
|
|
Run when a client is resized.
|
2016-10-16 22:06:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It client-session-changed
|
|
|
|
Run when a client's attached session is changed.
|
2015-12-16 21:50:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.It pane-died
|
|
|
|
Run when the program running in a pane exits, but
|
|
|
|
.Ic remain-on-exit
|
|
|
|
is on so the pane has not closed.
|
|
|
|
.It pane-exited
|
|
|
|
Run when the program running in a pane exits.
|
2018-07-04 12:25:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It pane-focus-in
|
|
|
|
Run when the focus enters a pane, if the
|
|
|
|
.Ic focus-events
|
|
|
|
option is on.
|
|
|
|
.It pane-focus-out
|
|
|
|
Run when the focus exits a pane, if the
|
|
|
|
.Ic focus-events
|
|
|
|
option is on.
|
2017-06-09 09:21:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.It pane-set-clipboard
|
|
|
|
Run when the terminal clipboard is set using the
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1
|
|
|
|
escape sequence.
|
2016-10-16 19:55:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.It session-created
|
|
|
|
Run when a new session created.
|
|
|
|
.It session-closed
|
|
|
|
Run when a session closed.
|
2016-10-15 00:09:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It session-renamed
|
|
|
|
Run when a session is renamed.
|
2016-10-16 22:06:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It window-linked
|
|
|
|
Run when a window is linked into a session.
|
2016-10-15 00:09:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It window-renamed
|
|
|
|
Run when a window is renamed.
|
2016-10-16 22:06:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It window-unlinked
|
|
|
|
Run when a window is unlinked from a session.
|
2015-12-08 01:10:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Hooks are managed with these commands:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic set-hook
|
2019-04-26 11:38:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl agRu
|
2015-12-08 01:10:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Ar hook-name
|
|
|
|
.Ar command
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2018-07-04 12:30:52 +00:00
|
|
|
Without
|
2018-07-04 13:27:32 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl R ,
|
2018-07-04 12:30:52 +00:00
|
|
|
sets (or with
|
2016-10-03 20:58:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl u
|
|
|
|
unsets) hook
|
2015-12-08 01:10:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar hook-name
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Ar command .
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl g
|
|
|
|
is given,
|
|
|
|
.Em hook-name
|
|
|
|
is added to the global list of hooks, otherwise it is added to the session
|
|
|
|
hooks (for
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Fl t ) .
|
2019-04-26 11:38:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
appends to a hook.
|
2015-12-08 01:10:31 +00:00
|
|
|
Like options, session hooks inherit from the global ones.
|
2018-07-04 12:30:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl R ,
|
|
|
|
run
|
|
|
|
.Ar hook-name
|
|
|
|
immediately.
|
2015-12-08 01:10:31 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic show-hooks
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl g
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Shows the global list of hooks with
|
|
|
|
.Fl g ,
|
|
|
|
otherwise the session hooks.
|
2015-12-08 06:42:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh MOUSE SUPPORT
|
|
|
|
If the
|
|
|
|
.Ic mouse
|
|
|
|
option is on (the default is off),
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
allows mouse events to be bound as keys.
|
|
|
|
The name of each key is made up of a mouse event (such as
|
|
|
|
.Ql MouseUp1 )
|
2019-03-25 18:59:55 +00:00
|
|
|
and a location suffix, one of the following:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "XXXXXXXXXXXXX" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Pane" Ta "the contents of a pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Border" Ta "a pane border"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Status" Ta "the status line window list"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "StatusLeft" Ta "the left part of the status line"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "StatusRight" Ta "the right part of the status line"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "StatusDefault" Ta "any other part of the status line"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
The following mouse events are available:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "MouseDown1" "MouseDrag1" "WheelDown" -offset indent
|
2016-10-11 09:30:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "WheelUp" Ta "WheelDown" Ta ""
|
2016-03-18 07:28:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "MouseDown1" Ta "MouseUp1" Ta "MouseDrag1" Ta "MouseDragEnd1"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "MouseDown2" Ta "MouseUp2" Ta "MouseDrag2" Ta "MouseDragEnd2"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "MouseDown3" Ta "MouseUp3" Ta "MouseDrag3" Ta "MouseDragEnd3"
|
2017-12-22 10:16:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "DoubleClick1" Ta "DoubleClick2" Ta "DoubleClick3"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "TripleClick1" Ta "TripleClick2" Ta "TripleClick3"
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Each should be suffixed with a location, for example
|
|
|
|
.Ql MouseDown1Status .
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-04-27 16:25:57 +00:00
|
|
|
The special token
|
|
|
|
.Ql {mouse}
|
|
|
|
or
|
2015-04-19 21:34:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql =
|
|
|
|
may be used as
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-window
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
in commands bound to mouse key bindings.
|
|
|
|
It resolves to the window or pane over which the mouse event took place
|
|
|
|
(for example, the window in the status line over which button 1 was released for a
|
|
|
|
.Ql MouseUp1Status
|
|
|
|
binding, or the pane over which the wheel was scrolled for a
|
|
|
|
.Ql WheelDownPane
|
|
|
|
binding).
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ic send-keys
|
|
|
|
.Fl M
|
|
|
|
flag may be used to forward a mouse event to a pane.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The default key bindings allow the mouse to be used to select and resize panes,
|
|
|
|
to copy text and to change window using the status line.
|
|
|
|
These take effect if the
|
|
|
|
.Ic mouse
|
|
|
|
option is turned on.
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh FORMATS
|
2012-05-22 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
Certain commands accept the
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
flag with a
|
|
|
|
.Ar format
|
|
|
|
argument.
|
|
|
|
This is a string which controls the output format of the command.
|
|
|
|
Replacement variables are enclosed in
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql } ,
|
|
|
|
for example
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #{session_name} .
|
2014-12-02 23:19:45 +00:00
|
|
|
The possible variables are listed in the table below, or the name of a
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
option may be used for an option's value.
|
|
|
|
Some variables have a shorter alias such as
|
2018-05-22 08:49:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #S ;
|
2013-11-24 11:29:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql ##
|
|
|
|
is replaced by a single
|
2018-05-22 08:49:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql # ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql #,
|
|
|
|
by a
|
|
|
|
.Ql \&,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql #}
|
|
|
|
by a
|
|
|
|
.Ql } .
|
2014-12-02 23:19:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Conditionals are available by prefixing with
|
2011-09-21 16:33:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql \&?
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
and separating two alternatives with a comma;
|
|
|
|
if the specified variable exists and is not zero, the first alternative
|
2011-09-21 16:33:19 +00:00
|
|
|
is chosen, otherwise the second is used.
|
|
|
|
For example
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #{?session_attached,attached,not attached}
|
|
|
|
will include the string
|
|
|
|
.Ql attached
|
|
|
|
if the session is attached and the string
|
|
|
|
.Ql not attached
|
2014-12-02 23:19:45 +00:00
|
|
|
if it is unattached, or
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{?automatic-rename,yes,no}
|
|
|
|
will include
|
|
|
|
.Ql yes
|
|
|
|
if
|
|
|
|
.Ic automatic-rename
|
|
|
|
is enabled, or
|
|
|
|
.Ql no
|
|
|
|
if not.
|
2018-05-28 11:45:26 +00:00
|
|
|
Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily.
|
|
|
|
Inside a conditional,
|
|
|
|
.Ql \&,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql }
|
|
|
|
must be escaped as
|
|
|
|
.Ql #,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql #} ,
|
|
|
|
unless they are part of a
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{...}
|
2018-06-03 10:17:30 +00:00
|
|
|
replacement.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
2018-05-28 11:45:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
#{?pane_in_mode,#[fg=white#,bg=red],#[fg=red#,bg=white]}#W .
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2015-10-25 22:29:17 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-05-29 18:06:34 +00:00
|
|
|
Comparisons may be expressed by prefixing two comma-separated
|
2017-01-09 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
alternatives by
|
2019-05-25 16:51:10 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql == ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql != ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql < ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql > ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql <=
|
2017-01-09 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
or
|
2019-05-25 16:51:10 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql >=
|
2017-01-09 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
and a colon.
|
|
|
|
For example
|
2017-04-22 06:15:22 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #{==:#{host},myhost}
|
2017-01-09 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
will be replaced by
|
|
|
|
.Ql 1
|
|
|
|
if running on
|
|
|
|
.Ql myhost ,
|
|
|
|
otherwise by
|
2017-05-29 18:06:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql 0 .
|
|
|
|
.Ql ||
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql &&
|
|
|
|
evaluate to true if either or both of two comma-separated alternatives are
|
|
|
|
true, for example
|
2018-04-18 12:50:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #{||:#{pane_in_mode},#{alternate_on}} .
|
2019-06-13 19:46:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
An
|
|
|
|
.Ql m
|
|
|
|
specifies an
|
|
|
|
.Xr fnmatch 3
|
|
|
|
or regular expression comparison.
|
|
|
|
The first argument is the pattern and the second the string to compare.
|
|
|
|
An optional third argument specifies flags:
|
|
|
|
.Ql r
|
|
|
|
means the pattern is a regular expression instead of the default
|
|
|
|
.Xr fnmatch 3
|
|
|
|
pattern, and
|
|
|
|
.Ql i
|
|
|
|
means to ignore case.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{m:*foo*,#{host}}
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{m/ri:^A,MYVAR} .
|
2017-05-29 18:06:34 +00:00
|
|
|
A
|
|
|
|
.Ql C
|
|
|
|
performs a search for an
|
|
|
|
.Xr fnmatch 3
|
2019-06-13 19:46:00 +00:00
|
|
|
pattern or regular expression in the pane content and evaluates to zero if not
|
|
|
|
found, or a line number if found.
|
|
|
|
Like
|
|
|
|
.Ql m ,
|
2019-06-13 21:04:21 +00:00
|
|
|
an
|
2019-06-13 19:46:00 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql r
|
|
|
|
flag means search for a regular expression and
|
|
|
|
.Ql i
|
|
|
|
ignores case.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{C/r:^Start}
|
2017-01-09 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2013-08-03 20:06:38 +00:00
|
|
|
A limit may be placed on the length of the resultant string by prefixing it
|
|
|
|
by an
|
|
|
|
.Ql = ,
|
2016-01-31 09:54:46 +00:00
|
|
|
a number and a colon.
|
|
|
|
Positive numbers count from the start of the string and negative from the end,
|
|
|
|
so
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{=5:pane_title}
|
2019-05-26 12:02:42 +00:00
|
|
|
will include at most the first five characters of the pane title, or
|
2016-01-31 09:54:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #{=-5:pane_title}
|
2019-05-26 12:02:42 +00:00
|
|
|
the last five characters.
|
|
|
|
A suffix or prefix may be given as a second argument - if provided then it is
|
|
|
|
appended or prepended to the string if the length has been trimmed, for example
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{=/5/...:pane_title}
|
|
|
|
will append
|
|
|
|
.Ql ...
|
|
|
|
if the pane title is more than five characters.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-10-25 22:29:17 +00:00
|
|
|
Prefixing a time variable with
|
|
|
|
.Ql t:
|
|
|
|
will convert it to a string, so if
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{window_activity}
|
|
|
|
gives
|
2015-10-26 00:15:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql 1445765102 ,
|
2015-10-25 22:29:17 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #{t:window_activity}
|
|
|
|
gives
|
|
|
|
.Ql Sun Oct 25 09:25:02 2015 .
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ql b:
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql d:
|
|
|
|
prefixes are
|
|
|
|
.Xr basename 3
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Xr dirname 3
|
|
|
|
of the variable respectively.
|
2018-08-26 09:28:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql q:
|
|
|
|
will escape
|
|
|
|
.Xr sh 1
|
|
|
|
special characters.
|
2019-03-13 14:19:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql E:
|
|
|
|
will expand the format twice, for example
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{E:status-left}
|
|
|
|
is the result of expanding the content of the
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-left
|
2019-06-21 07:11:01 +00:00
|
|
|
option rather than the option itself.
|
2019-03-14 21:31:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql T:
|
|
|
|
is like
|
|
|
|
.Ql E:
|
|
|
|
but also expands
|
|
|
|
.Xr strftime 3
|
|
|
|
specifiers.
|
2019-03-13 15:37:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql S: ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql W:
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql P:
|
|
|
|
will loop over each session, window or pane and insert the format once
|
2019-03-14 06:36:21 +00:00
|
|
|
for each.
|
|
|
|
For windows and panes, two comma-separated formats may be given:
|
|
|
|
the second is used for the current window or active pane.
|
|
|
|
For example, to get a list of windows formatted like the status line:
|
2019-03-13 15:37:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
#{W:#{E:window-status-format} ,#{E:window-status-current-format} }
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2019-03-18 20:53:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2015-11-18 14:13:55 +00:00
|
|
|
A prefix of the form
|
|
|
|
.Ql s/foo/bar/:
|
|
|
|
will substitute
|
|
|
|
.Ql foo
|
|
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
.Ql bar
|
|
|
|
throughout.
|
2019-06-13 19:46:00 +00:00
|
|
|
The first argument may be an extended regular expression and a final argument may be
|
|
|
|
.Ql i
|
|
|
|
to ignore case, for example
|
2019-06-13 21:04:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql s/a(.)/\e1x/i:
|
2019-06-13 19:46:00 +00:00
|
|
|
would change
|
|
|
|
.Ql abABab
|
|
|
|
into
|
|
|
|
.Ql bxBxbx .
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-06-21 07:11:01 +00:00
|
|
|
In addition, the last line of a shell command's output may be inserted using
|
2015-05-27 13:28:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql #() .
|
|
|
|
For example,
|
|
|
|
.Ql #(uptime)
|
|
|
|
will insert the system's uptime.
|
|
|
|
When constructing formats,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
does not wait for
|
|
|
|
.Ql #()
|
|
|
|
commands to finish; instead, the previous result from running the same command is used,
|
|
|
|
or a placeholder if the command has not been run before.
|
2017-04-20 09:20:22 +00:00
|
|
|
If the command hasn't exited, the most recent line of output will be used, but the status
|
|
|
|
line will not be updated more than once a second.
|
2015-05-27 13:28:04 +00:00
|
|
|
Commands are executed with the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
global environment set (see the
|
2019-05-07 14:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx GLOBAL AND SESSION ENVIRONMENT
|
2015-05-27 13:28:04 +00:00
|
|
|
section).
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-06-21 07:11:01 +00:00
|
|
|
An
|
|
|
|
.Ql l
|
|
|
|
specifies that a string should be interpreted literally and not expanded.
|
|
|
|
For example
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{l:#{?pane_in_mode,yes,no}}
|
|
|
|
will be replaced by
|
|
|
|
.Ql #{?pane_in_mode,yes,no} .
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
The following variables are available, where appropriate:
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -column "XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX" "XXXXX"
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Variable name" Ta Sy "Alias" Ta Sy "Replaced with"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "alternate_on" Ta "" Ta "If pane is in alternate screen"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "alternate_saved_x" Ta "" Ta "Saved cursor X in alternate screen"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "alternate_saved_y" Ta "" Ta "Saved cursor Y in alternate screen"
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "buffer_created" Ta "" Ta "Time buffer created"
|
2016-06-15 14:43:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "buffer_name" Ta "" Ta "Name of buffer"
|
2014-04-02 18:12:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "buffer_sample" Ta "" Ta "Sample of start of buffer"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "buffer_size" Ta "" Ta "Size of the specified buffer in bytes"
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_activity" Ta "" Ta "Time client last had activity"
|
2015-07-13 15:37:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_control_mode" Ta "" Ta "1 if client is in control mode"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_created" Ta "" Ta "Time client created"
|
2017-04-19 06:52:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_discarded" Ta "" Ta "Bytes discarded when client behind"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_height" Ta "" Ta "Height of client"
|
2015-10-21 13:14:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_key_table" Ta "" Ta "Current key table"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_last_session" Ta "" Ta "Name of the client's last session"
|
2017-04-05 10:49:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_name" Ta "" Ta "Name of client"
|
2015-06-14 10:07:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_pid" Ta "" Ta "PID of client process"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_prefix" Ta "" Ta "1 if prefix key has been pressed"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "client_readonly" Ta "" Ta "1 if client is readonly"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "client_session" Ta "" Ta "Name of the client's session"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "client_termname" Ta "" Ta "Terminal name of client"
|
2017-01-11 16:09:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_termtype" Ta "" Ta "Terminal type of client"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_tty" Ta "" Ta "Pseudo terminal of client"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "client_utf8" Ta "" Ta "1 if client supports utf8"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "client_width" Ta "" Ta "Width of client"
|
2017-04-18 15:44:17 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "client_written" Ta "" Ta "Bytes written to client"
|
2016-10-16 17:55:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "command" Ta "" Ta "Name of command in use, if any"
|
2016-06-15 08:54:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "command_list_alias" Ta "" Ta "Command alias if listing commands"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "command_list_name" Ta "" Ta "Command name if listing commands"
|
2016-06-15 08:54:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "command_list_usage" Ta "" Ta "Command usage if listing commands"
|
2019-03-25 14:29:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor_character" Ta "" Ta "Character at cursor in pane"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane cursor flag"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor_x" Ta "" Ta "Cursor X position in pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "cursor_y" Ta "" Ta "Cursor Y position in pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "history_bytes" Ta "" Ta "Number of bytes in window history"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "history_limit" Ta "" Ta "Maximum window history lines"
|
2017-10-08 16:45:01 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "history_size" Ta "" Ta "Size of history in lines"
|
2016-10-16 17:55:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "hook" Ta "" Ta "Name of running hook, if any"
|
2016-10-16 22:06:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "hook_pane" Ta "" Ta "ID of pane where hook was run, if any"
|
2016-10-16 19:55:52 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "hook_session" Ta "" Ta "ID of session where hook was run, if any"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "hook_session_name" Ta "" Ta "Name of session where hook was run, if any"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "hook_window" Ta "" Ta "ID of window where hook was run, if any"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "hook_window_name" Ta "" Ta "Name of window where hook was run, if any"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "host" Ta "#H" Ta "Hostname of local host"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "host_short" Ta "#h" Ta "Hostname of local host (no domain name)"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "insert_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane insert flag"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "keypad_cursor_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane keypad cursor flag"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "keypad_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane keypad flag"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "line" Ta "" Ta "Line number in the list"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_all_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane mouse all flag"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_any_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane mouse any flag"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_button_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane mouse button flag"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_standard_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane mouse standard flag"
|
2019-05-26 17:34:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_x" Ta "" Ta "Mouse X position, if any"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_y" Ta "" Ta "Mouse Y position, if any"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_word" Ta "" Ta "Word under mouse, if any"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "mouse_line" Ta "" Ta "Line under mouse, if any"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_active" Ta "" Ta "1 if active pane"
|
2017-07-27 10:42:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_at_bottom" Ta "" Ta "1 if pane is at the bottom of window"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_at_left" Ta "" Ta "1 if pane is at the left of window"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_at_right" Ta "" Ta "1 if pane is at the right of window"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_at_top" Ta "" Ta "1 if pane is at the top of window"
|
2014-05-27 12:49:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_bottom" Ta "" Ta "Bottom of pane"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_current_command" Ta "" Ta "Current command if available"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_current_path" Ta "" Ta "Current path if available"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_dead" Ta "" Ta "1 if pane is dead"
|
2014-12-09 19:23:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_dead_status" Ta "" Ta "Exit status of process in dead pane"
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_format" Ta "" Ta "1 if format is for a pane (not assuming the current)"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_height" Ta "" Ta "Height of pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_id" Ta "#D" Ta "Unique pane ID"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_in_mode" Ta "" Ta "If pane is in a mode"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_index" Ta "#P" Ta "Index of pane"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_input_off" Ta "" Ta "If input to pane is disabled"
|
2014-05-27 12:49:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_left" Ta "" Ta "Left of pane"
|
2019-05-21 07:01:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_marked" Ta "" Ta "1 if this is the marked pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_marked_set" Ta "" Ta "1 if a marked pane is set"
|
2017-05-07 22:27:57 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_mode" Ta "" Ta "Name of pane mode, if any."
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_pid" Ta "" Ta "PID of first process in pane"
|
2017-07-07 14:39:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_pipe" Ta "" Ta "1 if pane is being piped"
|
2014-05-27 12:49:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_right" Ta "" Ta "Right of pane"
|
2017-05-03 05:53:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_search_string" Ta "" Ta "Last search string in copy mode"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_start_command" Ta "" Ta "Command pane started with"
|
2014-05-27 12:49:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_synchronized" Ta "" Ta "If pane is synchronized"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_tabs" Ta "" Ta "Pane tab positions"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_title" Ta "#T" Ta "Title of pane"
|
2014-05-27 12:49:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_top" Ta "" Ta "Top of pane"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_tty" Ta "" Ta "Pseudo terminal of pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "pane_width" Ta "" Ta "Width of pane"
|
2015-06-14 10:07:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "pid" Ta "" Ta "Server PID"
|
2018-07-06 07:11:23 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "rectangle_toggle" Ta "" Ta "1 if rectangle selection is activated"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "scroll_position" Ta "" Ta "Scroll position in copy mode"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "scroll_region_lower" Ta "" Ta "Bottom of scroll region in pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "scroll_region_upper" Ta "" Ta "Top of scroll region in pane"
|
2017-08-02 11:10:48 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "selection_present" Ta "" Ta "1 if selection started in copy mode"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_activity" Ta "" Ta "Time of session last activity"
|
2015-05-12 15:29:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_alerts" Ta "" Ta "List of window indexes with alerts"
|
2014-03-06 11:25:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_attached" Ta "" Ta "Number of clients session is attached to"
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_created" Ta "" Ta "Time session created"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "session_format" Ta "" Ta "1 if format is for a session (not assuming the current)"
|
2017-02-09 15:04:53 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_group" Ta "" Ta "Name of session group"
|
2017-11-02 18:52:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_group_list" Ta "" Ta "List of sessions in group"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_group_size" Ta "" Ta "Size of session group"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_grouped" Ta "" Ta "1 if session in a group"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "session_id" Ta "" Ta "Unique session ID"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_last_attached" Ta "" Ta "Time session last attached"
|
2014-03-06 11:25:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_many_attached" Ta "" Ta "1 if multiple clients attached"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_name" Ta "#S" Ta "Name of session"
|
2017-05-05 11:59:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_stack" Ta "" Ta "Window indexes in most recent order"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "session_windows" Ta "" Ta "Number of windows in session"
|
2016-05-01 11:46:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "socket_path" Ta "" Ta "Server socket path"
|
2015-11-24 21:52:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "start_time" Ta "" Ta "Server start time"
|
2017-01-09 21:44:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "version" Ta "" Ta "Server version"
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_active" Ta "" Ta "1 if window active"
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_activity" Ta "" Ta "Time of window last activity"
|
2016-05-01 11:46:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_activity_flag" Ta "" Ta "1 if window has activity"
|
2013-08-01 22:41:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_bell_flag" Ta "" Ta "1 if window has bell"
|
2018-09-26 17:41:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_bigger" Ta "" Ta "1 if window is larger than client"
|
2019-03-14 21:41:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_end_flag" Ta "" Ta "1 if window has the highest index"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_flags" Ta "#F" Ta "Window flags"
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_format" Ta "" Ta "1 if format is for a window (not assuming the current)"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_height" Ta "" Ta "Height of window"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "window_id" Ta "" Ta "Unique window ID"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "window_index" Ta "#I" Ta "Index of window"
|
2014-09-08 14:29:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_last_flag" Ta "" Ta "1 if window is the last used"
|
2015-11-13 10:00:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_layout" Ta "" Ta "Window layout description, ignoring zoomed window panes"
|
2015-05-06 08:35:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_linked" Ta "" Ta "1 if window is linked across sessions"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_name" Ta "#W" Ta "Name of window"
|
2018-09-26 17:41:18 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_offset_x" Ta "" Ta "X offset into window if larger than client"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "window_offset_y" Ta "" Ta "Y offset into window if larger than client"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_panes" Ta "" Ta "Number of panes in window"
|
2013-08-01 22:41:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_silence_flag" Ta "" Ta "1 if window has silence alert"
|
2017-05-05 11:59:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_stack_index" Ta "" Ta "Index in session most recent stack"
|
2019-03-14 21:41:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_start_flag" Ta "" Ta "1 if window has the lowest index"
|
2015-11-13 10:00:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_visible_layout" Ta "" Ta "Window layout description, respecting zoomed window panes"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_width" Ta "" Ta "Width of window"
|
2014-09-08 14:29:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "window_zoomed_flag" Ta "" Ta "1 if window is zoomed"
|
2013-05-31 19:56:05 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "wrap_flag" Ta "" Ta "Pane wrap flag"
|
2011-09-21 16:31:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh STYLES
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
offers various options to specify the colour and attributes of aspects of the
|
|
|
|
interface, for example
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-style
|
|
|
|
for the status line.
|
|
|
|
In addition, embedded styles may be specified in format options, such as
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-left-format ,
|
|
|
|
by enclosing them in
|
|
|
|
.Ql #[
|
|
|
|
and
|
2019-04-25 15:35:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql \&] .
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
A style may be the single term
|
|
|
|
.Ql default
|
|
|
|
to specify the default style (which may inherit from another option) or a space
|
2019-03-22 10:45:17 +00:00
|
|
|
or comma separated list of the following:
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Ic fg=colour
|
|
|
|
Set the foreground colour.
|
|
|
|
The colour is one of:
|
|
|
|
.Ic black ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic red ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic green ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic yellow ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic blue ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic magenta ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic cyan ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic white ;
|
|
|
|
if supported the bright variants
|
|
|
|
.Ic brightred ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic brightgreen ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic brightyellow ;
|
|
|
|
.Ic colour0
|
|
|
|
to
|
|
|
|
.Ic colour255
|
|
|
|
from the 256-colour set;
|
|
|
|
.Ic default
|
|
|
|
for the default colour;
|
|
|
|
.Ic terminal
|
|
|
|
for the terminal default colour; or a hexadecimal RGB string such as
|
|
|
|
.Ql #ffffff .
|
|
|
|
.It Ic bg=colour
|
|
|
|
Set the background colour.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic none
|
|
|
|
Set no attributes (turn off any active attributes).
|
2019-03-18 20:53:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic bright
|
|
|
|
(or
|
|
|
|
.Ic bold ) ,
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic dim ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic underscore ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic blink ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic reverse ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic hidden ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic italics ,
|
2019-05-13 20:10:23 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic overline ,
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic strikethrough ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic double-underscore ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic curly-underscore ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic dotted-underscore ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic dashed-underscore
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Set an attribute.
|
|
|
|
Any of the attributes may be prefixed with
|
|
|
|
.Ql no
|
|
|
|
to unset.
|
2019-03-18 20:53:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic align=left
|
|
|
|
(or
|
|
|
|
.Ic noalign ) ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic align=centre ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic align=right
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Align text to the left, centre or right of the available space if appropriate.
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic list=on ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic list=focus ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic list=left-marker ,
|
2019-05-30 07:42:41 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic list=right-marker ,
|
2019-03-18 20:53:33 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic nolist
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Mark the position of the various window list components in the
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-format
|
|
|
|
option:
|
|
|
|
.Ic list=on
|
|
|
|
marks the start of the list;
|
|
|
|
.Ic list=focus
|
|
|
|
is the part of the list that should be kept in focus if the entire list won't fit
|
|
|
|
in the available space (typically the current window);
|
|
|
|
.Ic list=left-marker
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic list=right-marker
|
|
|
|
mark the text to be used to mark that text has been trimmed from the left or
|
|
|
|
right of the list if there is not enough space.
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic range=left ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic range=right ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic range=window|X ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic norange
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Mark a range in the
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic status-format
|
2019-03-18 20:53:33 +00:00
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
.Ic range=left
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic range=right
|
|
|
|
are the text used for the
|
|
|
|
.Ql StatusLeft
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql StatusRight
|
|
|
|
mouse keys.
|
|
|
|
.Ic range=window|X
|
|
|
|
is the range for a window passed to the
|
|
|
|
.Ql Status
|
|
|
|
mouse key, where
|
|
|
|
.Ql X
|
|
|
|
is a window index.
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Examples are:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
2019-03-22 10:45:17 +00:00
|
|
|
fg=yellow bold underscore blink
|
2019-03-17 19:33:12 +00:00
|
|
|
bg=black,fg=default,noreverse
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh NAMES AND TITLES
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
distinguishes between names and titles.
|
|
|
|
Windows and sessions have names, which may be used to specify them in targets
|
|
|
|
and are displayed in the status line and various lists: the name is the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
identifier for a window or session.
|
|
|
|
Only panes have titles.
|
2017-09-02 17:51:54 +00:00
|
|
|
A pane's title is typically set by the program running inside the pane using
|
|
|
|
an escape sequence (like it would set the
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1
|
2017-09-02 17:51:54 +00:00
|
|
|
window title in
|
2017-09-04 09:18:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr X 7 ) .
|
2012-01-21 21:40:33 +00:00
|
|
|
Windows themselves do not have titles - a window's title is the title of its
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
active pane.
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
itself may set the title of the terminal in which the client is running, see
|
|
|
|
the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-titles
|
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
A session's name is set with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-session
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic rename-session
|
|
|
|
commands.
|
|
|
|
A window's name is set with one of:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -enum -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
A command argument (such as
|
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
|
|
|
for
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-window
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic new-session ) .
|
|
|
|
.It
|
2018-05-09 16:20:50 +00:00
|
|
|
An escape sequence (if the
|
|
|
|
.Ic allow-rename
|
|
|
|
option is turned on):
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ printf '\e033kWINDOW_NAME\e033\e\e'
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.It
|
|
|
|
Automatic renaming, which sets the name to the active command in the window's
|
|
|
|
active pane.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Ic automatic-rename
|
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
When a pane is first created, its title is the hostname.
|
2018-10-11 15:20:14 +00:00
|
|
|
A pane's title can be set via the title setting escape sequence, for example:
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ printf '\e033]2;My Title\e033\e\e'
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2017-09-02 17:51:54 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
It can also be modified with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic select-pane
|
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2019-05-07 14:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh GLOBAL AND SESSION ENVIRONMENT
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
When the server is started,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
copies the environment into the
|
|
|
|
.Em global environment ;
|
|
|
|
in addition, each session has a
|
|
|
|
.Em session environment .
|
2010-12-10 21:05:22 +00:00
|
|
|
When a window is created, the session and global environments are merged.
|
|
|
|
If a variable exists in both, the value from the session environment is used.
|
|
|
|
The result is the initial environment passed to the new process.
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ic update-environment
|
|
|
|
session option may be used to update the session environment from the client
|
|
|
|
when a new session is created or an old reattached.
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
also initialises the
|
|
|
|
.Ev TMUX
|
|
|
|
variable with some internal information to allow commands to be executed
|
|
|
|
from inside, and the
|
|
|
|
.Ev TERM
|
|
|
|
variable with the correct terminal setting of
|
|
|
|
.Ql screen .
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Commands to alter and view the environment are:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic set-environment
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl gru
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
.Ar name Op Ar value
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-11-02 21:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic setenv )
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
Set or unset an environment variable.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl g
|
|
|
|
is used, the change is made in the global environment; otherwise, it is applied
|
|
|
|
to the session environment for
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session .
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl u
|
|
|
|
flag unsets a variable.
|
|
|
|
.Fl r
|
|
|
|
indicates the variable is to be removed from the environment before starting a
|
|
|
|
new process.
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic show-environment
|
2015-07-13 13:36:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl gs
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-session
|
2012-03-29 21:10:10 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar variable
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-11-02 21:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic showenv )
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
Display the environment for
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-session
|
|
|
|
or the global environment with
|
|
|
|
.Fl g .
|
2012-03-29 21:10:10 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar variable
|
|
|
|
is omitted, all variables are shown.
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
Variables removed from the environment are prefixed with
|
|
|
|
.Ql - .
|
2015-07-13 13:36:29 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
|
|
|
is used, the output is formatted as a set of Bourne shell commands.
|
2009-08-09 17:48:55 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh STATUS LINE
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
includes an optional status line which is displayed in the bottom line of each
|
|
|
|
terminal.
|
2019-03-18 21:01:04 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
By default, the status line is enabled and one line in height (it may be
|
|
|
|
disabled or made multiple lines with the
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic status
|
|
|
|
session option) and contains, from left-to-right: the name of the current
|
2012-01-03 18:36:40 +00:00
|
|
|
session in square brackets; the window list; the title of the active pane
|
|
|
|
in double quotes; and the time and date.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-03-18 21:01:04 +00:00
|
|
|
Each line of the status line is configured with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-format
|
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
The default is made of three parts: configurable left and right sections (which
|
|
|
|
may contain dynamic content such as the time or output from a shell command,
|
|
|
|
see the
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic status-left ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-left-length ,
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-right ,
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-right-length
|
|
|
|
options below), and a central window list.
|
2009-11-19 22:35:10 +00:00
|
|
|
By default, the window list shows the index, name and (if any) flag of the
|
|
|
|
windows present in the current session in ascending numerical order.
|
|
|
|
It may be customised with the
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-status-format
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-status-current-format
|
|
|
|
options.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
The flag is one of the following symbols appended to the window name:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "Symbol" "Meaning" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Symbol" Ta Sy "Meaning"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "*" Ta "Denotes the current window."
|
|
|
|
.It Li "-" Ta "Marks the last window (previously selected)."
|
2017-08-17 08:37:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "#" Ta "Window activity is monitored and activity has been detected."
|
|
|
|
.It Li "\&!" Ta "Window bells are monitored and a bell has occurred in the window."
|
2010-12-06 22:52:21 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "~" Ta "The window has been silent for the monitor-silence interval."
|
2015-06-04 11:43:51 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "M" Ta "The window contains the marked pane."
|
2013-03-12 14:58:48 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "Z" Ta "The window's active pane is zoomed."
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The # symbol relates to the
|
|
|
|
.Ic monitor-activity
|
2014-04-17 07:36:45 +00:00
|
|
|
window option.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
The window name is printed in inverted colours if an alert (bell, activity or
|
2014-04-17 07:36:45 +00:00
|
|
|
silence) is present.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-12-04 22:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
The colour and attributes of the status line may be configured, the entire
|
|
|
|
status line using the
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic status-style
|
|
|
|
session option and individual windows using the
|
|
|
|
.Ic window-status-style
|
|
|
|
window option.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-12-04 22:16:15 +00:00
|
|
|
The status line is automatically refreshed at interval if it has changed, the
|
|
|
|
interval may be controlled with the
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic status-interval
|
|
|
|
session option.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Commands related to the status line are as follows:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic command-prompt
|
2017-01-06 11:57:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl 1i
|
2011-07-03 21:52:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl I Ar inputs
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl p Ar prompts
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.Op Ar template
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
Open the command prompt in a client.
|
|
|
|
This may be used from inside
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
to execute commands interactively.
|
2011-05-22 16:26:38 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
is specified, it is used as the command.
|
2011-07-03 21:52:50 +00:00
|
|
|
If present,
|
|
|
|
.Fl I
|
|
|
|
is a comma-separated list of the initial text for each prompt.
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
|
|
|
is given,
|
|
|
|
.Ar prompts
|
|
|
|
is a comma-separated list of prompts which are displayed in order; otherwise
|
|
|
|
a single prompt is displayed, constructed from
|
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
if it is present, or
|
|
|
|
.Ql \&:
|
|
|
|
if not.
|
2011-07-03 21:52:50 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
Before the command is executed, the first occurrence of the string
|
|
|
|
.Ql %%
|
2009-08-20 11:53:27 +00:00
|
|
|
and all occurrences of
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql %1
|
2016-08-03 09:08:40 +00:00
|
|
|
are replaced by the response to the first prompt, all
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql %2
|
|
|
|
are replaced with the response to the second prompt, and so on for further
|
2009-08-20 11:53:27 +00:00
|
|
|
prompts.
|
|
|
|
Up to nine prompt responses may be replaced
|
|
|
|
.Po
|
|
|
|
.Ql %1
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
to
|
2009-08-20 11:53:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql %9
|
|
|
|
.Pc .
|
2016-10-21 13:51:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql %%%
|
|
|
|
is like
|
|
|
|
.Ql %%
|
|
|
|
but any quotation marks are escaped.
|
2016-10-11 07:23:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl 1
|
|
|
|
makes the prompt only accept one key press, in this case the resulting input
|
|
|
|
is a single character.
|
2017-01-06 11:57:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl i
|
|
|
|
executes the command every time the prompt input changes instead of when the
|
|
|
|
user exits the command prompt.
|
2016-10-12 14:50:14 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The following keys have a special meaning in the command prompt, depending
|
|
|
|
on the value of the
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-keys
|
|
|
|
option:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "FunctionXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX" "viXXXX" "emacsX" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Function" Ta Sy "vi" Ta Sy "emacs"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Cancel command prompt" Ta "Escape" Ta "Escape"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Delete current word" Ta "" Ta "C-w"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Delete entire command" Ta "d" Ta "C-u"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Delete from cursor to end" Ta "D" Ta "C-k"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Execute command" Ta "Enter" Ta "Enter"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Get next command from history" Ta "" Ta "Down"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Get previous command from history" Ta "" Ta "Up"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Insert top paste buffer" Ta "p" Ta "C-y"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Look for completions" Ta "Tab" Ta "Tab"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Move cursor left" Ta "h" Ta "Left"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Move cursor right" Ta "l" Ta "Right"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Move cursor to end" Ta "$" Ta "C-e"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Move cursor to next word" Ta "w" Ta "M-f"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Move cursor to previous word" Ta "b" Ta "M-b"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Move cursor to start" Ta "0" Ta "C-a"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Transpose characters" Ta "" Ta "C-t"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic confirm-before
|
2011-07-08 08:42:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl p Ar prompt
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.Ar command
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic confirm )
|
|
|
|
Ask for confirmation before executing
|
|
|
|
.Ar command .
|
2011-07-08 08:42:03 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
|
|
|
is given,
|
|
|
|
.Ar prompt
|
|
|
|
is the prompt to display; otherwise a prompt is constructed from
|
|
|
|
.Ar command .
|
|
|
|
It may contain the special character sequences supported by the
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-left
|
|
|
|
option.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
This command works only from inside
|
|
|
|
.Nm .
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic display-menu
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl T Ar title
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl x Ar position
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl y Ar position
|
2019-05-28 07:18:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar name
|
|
|
|
.Ar key
|
|
|
|
.Ar command
|
|
|
|
.Ar ...
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2019-05-23 11:13:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic menu )
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
Display a menu on
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-client .
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
gives the target for any commands run from the menu.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-05-28 07:18:42 +00:00
|
|
|
A menu is passed as a series of arguments: first the menu item name,
|
|
|
|
second the key shortcut (or empty for none) and third the command
|
|
|
|
to run when the menu item is chosen.
|
|
|
|
The name and command are formats, see the
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Sx STYLES
|
|
|
|
sections.
|
2019-05-28 09:50:54 +00:00
|
|
|
If the name begins with a hyphen (-), then the item is disabled (shown dim) and
|
|
|
|
may not be chosen.
|
2019-05-28 07:18:42 +00:00
|
|
|
The name may be empty for a separator line, in which case both the key and
|
|
|
|
command should be omitted.
|
2019-05-10 18:04:06 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl T
|
|
|
|
is a format for the menu title (see
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS ) .
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl x
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Fl y
|
|
|
|
give the position of the menu.
|
|
|
|
Both may be a row or column number, or one of the following special values:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "XXXXX" "XXXX" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Value" Ta Sy "Flag" Ta Sy "Meaning"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "R" Ta Fl x Ta "The right side of the terminal"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "P" Ta "Both" Ta "The bottom left of the pane"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "M" Ta "Both" Ta "The mouse position"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "W" Ta Fl x Ta "The window position on the status line"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "S" Ta Fl y Ta "The line above or below the status line"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Each menu consists of items followed by a key shortcut shown in brackets.
|
|
|
|
If the menu is too large to fit on the terminal, it is not displayed.
|
|
|
|
Pressing the key shortcut chooses the corresponding item.
|
|
|
|
If the mouse is enabled and the menu is opened from a mouse key binding, releasing
|
|
|
|
the mouse button with an item selected will choose that item.
|
|
|
|
The following keys are also available:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "Key" "Function" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Key" Ta Sy "Function"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Enter" Ta "Choose selected item"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Up" Ta "Select previous item"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Down" Ta "Select next item"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "q" Ta "Exit menu"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic display-message
|
2019-05-03 20:44:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl aIpv
|
2011-04-06 22:21:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl c Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar message
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic display )
|
2009-11-28 14:39:53 +00:00
|
|
|
Display a message.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
|
|
|
is given, the output is printed to stdout, otherwise it is displayed in the
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-client
|
|
|
|
status line.
|
2009-11-19 22:25:52 +00:00
|
|
|
The format of
|
2009-11-19 22:32:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar message
|
2012-03-03 09:14:21 +00:00
|
|
|
is described in the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section; information is taken from
|
2011-04-06 22:21:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
if
|
|
|
|
.Fl t
|
|
|
|
is given, otherwise the active pane for the session attached to
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-client .
|
2019-03-15 10:04:13 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2019-03-18 14:10:25 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl v
|
|
|
|
prints verbose logging as the format is parsed and
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
lists the format variables and their values.
|
2019-05-03 20:44:24 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Fl I
|
|
|
|
forwards any input read from stdin to the empty pane given by
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Sh BUFFERS
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
maintains a set of named
|
2010-12-31 01:58:27 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em paste buffers .
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
Each buffer may be either explicitly or automatically named.
|
|
|
|
Explicitly named buffers are named when created with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-buffer
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ic load-buffer
|
|
|
|
commands, or by renaming an automatically named buffer with
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-buffer
|
|
|
|
.Fl n .
|
|
|
|
Automatically named buffers are given a name such as
|
|
|
|
.Ql buffer0001 ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql buffer0002
|
|
|
|
and so on.
|
|
|
|
When the
|
|
|
|
.Ic buffer-limit
|
|
|
|
option is reached, the oldest automatically named buffer is deleted.
|
2016-08-22 20:07:58 +00:00
|
|
|
Explicitly named buffers are not subject to
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic buffer-limit
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
and may be deleted with
|
|
|
|
.Ic delete-buffer
|
|
|
|
command.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Buffers may be added using
|
|
|
|
.Ic copy-mode
|
|
|
|
or the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-buffer
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic load-buffer
|
|
|
|
commands, and pasted into a window using the
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic paste-buffer
|
|
|
|
command.
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
If a buffer command is used and no buffer is specified, the most
|
|
|
|
recently added automatically named buffer is assumed.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
A configurable history buffer is also maintained for each window.
|
|
|
|
By default, up to 2000 lines are kept; this can be altered with the
|
|
|
|
.Ic history-limit
|
|
|
|
option (see the
|
|
|
|
.Ic set-option
|
|
|
|
command above).
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The buffer commands are as follows:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
2010-06-22 23:35:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo
|
|
|
|
.Ic choose-buffer
|
2018-02-28 08:55:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl NZ
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl f Ar filter
|
2017-06-09 15:29:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl O Ar sort-order
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2010-06-22 23:35:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Ar template
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
Put a pane into buffer mode, where a buffer may be chosen interactively from
|
|
|
|
a list.
|
2018-02-28 08:55:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl Z
|
|
|
|
zooms the pane.
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
The following keys may be used in buffer mode:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -column "Key" "Function" -offset indent
|
|
|
|
.It Sy "Key" Ta Sy "Function"
|
2017-10-25 11:26:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "Enter" Ta "Paste selected buffer"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "Up" Ta "Select previous buffer"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "Down" Ta "Select next buffer"
|
2017-06-07 14:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "C-s" Ta "Search by name or content"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "n" Ta "Repeat last search"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "t" Ta "Toggle if buffer is tagged"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "T" Ta "Tag no buffers"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "C-t" Ta "Tag all buffers"
|
2017-10-25 11:26:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "p" Ta "Paste selected buffer"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "P" Ta "Paste tagged buffers"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "d" Ta "Delete selected buffer"
|
|
|
|
.It Li "D" Ta "Delete tagged buffers"
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "f" Ta "Enter a format to filter items"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "O" Ta "Change sort order"
|
2017-08-23 09:39:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "v" Ta "Toggle preview"
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Li "q" Ta "Exit mode"
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
After a buffer is chosen,
|
2010-06-22 23:35:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ql %%
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
is replaced by the buffer name in
|
2010-06-22 23:35:20 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
and the result executed as a command.
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Ar template
|
|
|
|
is not given, "paste-buffer -b '%%'" is used.
|
Rewrite of choose mode, both to simplify and tidy the code and to add
some modern features.
Now the common code is in mode-tree.c, which provides an API used by the
three modes now separated into window-{buffer,client,tree}.c. Buffer
mode shows buffers, client mode clients and tree mode a tree of
sessions, windows and panes.
Each mode has a common set of key bindings plus a few that are specific
to the mode. Other changes are:
- each mode has a preview pane: for buffers this is the buffer content
(very useful), for others it is a preview of the pane;
- items may be sorted in different ways ('O' key);
- multiple items may be tagged and an operation applied to all of them
(for example, to delete multiple buffers at once);
- in tree mode a command may be run on the selected item (session,
window, pane) or on tagged items (key ':');
- displayed items may be filtered in tree mode by using a format (this
is used to implement find-window) (key 'f');
- the custom format (-F) for the display is no longer available;
- shortcut keys change from 0-9, a-z, A-Z which was always a bit weird
with keys used for other uses to 0-9, M-a to M-z.
Now that the code is simpler, other improvements will come later.
Primary key bindings for each mode are documented under the commands in
the man page (choose-buffer, choose-client, choose-tree).
Parts written by Thomas Adam.
2017-05-30 21:44:59 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-06-09 15:29:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl O
|
|
|
|
specifies the initial sort order: one of
|
|
|
|
.Ql time ,
|
|
|
|
.Ql name
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Ql size .
|
2017-06-09 16:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl f
|
2017-09-11 06:53:06 +00:00
|
|
|
specifies an initial filter: the filter is a format - if it evaluates to zero,
|
|
|
|
the item in the list is not shown, otherwise it is shown.
|
|
|
|
If a filter would lead to an empty list, it is ignored.
|
2017-08-09 11:43:45 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
specifies the format for each item in the list.
|
2017-08-23 09:39:11 +00:00
|
|
|
.Fl N
|
|
|
|
starts without the preview.
|
2013-02-10 17:52:51 +00:00
|
|
|
This command works only if at least one client is attached.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic clear-history Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic clearhist )
|
|
|
|
Remove and free the history for the specified pane.
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic delete-buffer Op Fl b Ar buffer-name
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic deleteb )
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
Delete the buffer named
|
|
|
|
.Ar buffer-name ,
|
|
|
|
or the most recently added automatically named buffer if not specified.
|
2012-05-22 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic list-buffers
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl F Ar format
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lsb )
|
2010-12-30 22:39:49 +00:00
|
|
|
List the global buffers.
|
2012-05-22 21:03:25 +00:00
|
|
|
For the meaning of the
|
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
flag, see the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2010-12-31 02:00:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic load-buffer
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b Ar buffer-name
|
2008-12-15 21:21:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar path
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic loadb )
|
|
|
|
Load the contents of the specified paste buffer from
|
2008-12-15 21:21:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar path .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic paste-buffer
|
2012-03-07 13:36:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl dpr
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b Ar buffer-name
|
2010-06-06 00:01:36 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl s Ar separator
|
2010-03-18 21:02:41 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-04-21 20:06:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic pasteb )
|
2010-03-18 21:02:41 +00:00
|
|
|
Insert the contents of a paste buffer into the specified pane.
|
|
|
|
If not specified, paste into the current one.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl d ,
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
also delete the paste buffer.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
When output, any linefeed (LF) characters in the paste buffer are replaced with
|
2010-06-06 00:01:36 +00:00
|
|
|
a separator, by default carriage return (CR).
|
|
|
|
A custom separator may be specified using the
|
|
|
|
.Fl s
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
flag.
|
2010-06-06 00:01:36 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl r
|
|
|
|
flag means to do no replacement (equivalent to a separator of LF).
|
2012-03-07 13:36:19 +00:00
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl p
|
|
|
|
is specified, paste bracket control codes are inserted around the
|
|
|
|
buffer if the application has requested bracketed paste mode.
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic save-buffer
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl a
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b Ar buffer-name
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar path
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic saveb )
|
|
|
|
Save the contents of the specified paste buffer to
|
|
|
|
.Ar path .
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
option appends to rather than overwriting the file.
|
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic set-buffer
|
2014-03-06 11:50:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl a
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b Ar buffer-name
|
|
|
|
.Op Fl n Ar new-buffer-name
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar data
|
2008-06-27 17:24:16 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic setb )
|
|
|
|
Set the contents of the specified buffer to
|
|
|
|
.Ar data .
|
2014-03-06 11:50:07 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl a
|
|
|
|
option appends to rather than overwriting the buffer.
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Fl n
|
|
|
|
option renames the buffer to
|
|
|
|
.Ar new-buffer-name .
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic show-buffer
|
2014-05-13 07:34:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b Ar buffer-name
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic showb )
|
|
|
|
Display the contents of the specified buffer.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
|
|
|
.Sh MISCELLANEOUS
|
|
|
|
Miscellaneous commands are as follows:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
2009-08-20 11:37:46 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic clock-mode Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
Display a large clock.
|
2013-02-23 22:25:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic if-shell
|
2014-12-02 23:39:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl bF
|
2013-02-23 19:24:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
2013-02-23 22:25:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command command
|
|
|
|
.Op Ar command
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic if )
|
2011-10-31 13:55:10 +00:00
|
|
|
Execute the first
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar command
|
2009-07-19 00:39:37 +00:00
|
|
|
if
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
2011-10-31 13:55:10 +00:00
|
|
|
returns success or the second
|
|
|
|
.Ar command
|
|
|
|
otherwise.
|
2014-12-02 23:39:02 +00:00
|
|
|
Before being executed,
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
is expanded using the rules specified in the
|
2013-02-23 19:24:42 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section, including those relevant to
|
|
|
|
.Ar target-pane .
|
2013-03-25 11:49:54 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl b ,
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
is run in the background.
|
2014-12-02 23:39:02 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If
|
|
|
|
.Fl F
|
|
|
|
is given,
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
is not executed but considered success if neither empty nor zero (after formats
|
|
|
|
are expanded).
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic lock-server
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic lock )
|
2009-09-23 15:00:09 +00:00
|
|
|
Lock each client individually by running the command specified by the
|
|
|
|
.Ic lock-command
|
|
|
|
option.
|
2012-11-27 15:09:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic run-shell
|
2013-04-24 10:15:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl b
|
2012-11-27 15:09:35 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl t Ar target-pane
|
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
2009-09-20 22:20:10 +00:00
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic run )
|
|
|
|
Execute
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar shell-command
|
2013-03-25 11:49:54 +00:00
|
|
|
in the background without creating a window.
|
2013-02-23 19:24:42 +00:00
|
|
|
Before being executed, shell-command is expanded using the rules specified in
|
|
|
|
the
|
|
|
|
.Sx FORMATS
|
|
|
|
section.
|
2013-03-25 11:49:54 +00:00
|
|
|
With
|
|
|
|
.Fl b ,
|
|
|
|
the command is run in the background.
|
2012-11-27 15:09:35 +00:00
|
|
|
After it finishes, any output to stdout is displayed in copy mode (in the pane
|
|
|
|
specified by
|
|
|
|
.Fl t
|
|
|
|
or the current pane if omitted).
|
2010-02-18 12:37:30 +00:00
|
|
|
If the command doesn't return success, the exit status is also displayed.
|
2013-03-06 09:57:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Xo Ic wait-for
|
2013-08-31 10:16:47 +00:00
|
|
|
.Op Fl L | S | U
|
2013-03-06 09:57:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar channel
|
|
|
|
.Xc
|
|
|
|
.D1 (alias: Ic wait )
|
2013-03-06 11:00:55 +00:00
|
|
|
When used without options, prevents the client from exiting until woken using
|
2013-03-06 09:57:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ic wait-for
|
|
|
|
.Fl S
|
|
|
|
with the same channel.
|
2013-03-06 11:00:55 +00:00
|
|
|
When
|
|
|
|
.Fl L
|
|
|
|
is used, the channel is locked and any clients that try to lock the same
|
|
|
|
channel are made to wait until the channel is unlocked with
|
|
|
|
.Ic wait-for
|
|
|
|
.Fl U .
|
2007-11-09 16:04:29 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2011-05-22 16:23:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh TERMINFO EXTENSIONS
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2016-01-29 11:13:56 +00:00
|
|
|
understands some unofficial extensions to
|
2011-05-22 16:23:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr terminfo 5 :
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
2013-06-02 07:52:15 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Em Cs , Cr
|
2011-06-23 19:19:08 +00:00
|
|
|
Set the cursor colour.
|
2011-05-22 16:26:58 +00:00
|
|
|
The first takes a single string argument and is used to set the colour;
|
|
|
|
the second takes no arguments and restores the default cursor colour.
|
|
|
|
If set, a sequence such as this may be used
|
|
|
|
to change the cursor colour from inside
|
|
|
|
.Nm :
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ printf '\e033]12;red\e033\e\e'
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2019-05-13 20:10:23 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Em \&Smol
|
|
|
|
Enable the overline attribute.
|
2019-06-27 15:17:41 +00:00
|
|
|
The capability is usually SGR 53 and can be added to
|
|
|
|
.Ic terminal-overrides
|
|
|
|
as:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
Smol=\eE[53m
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2018-10-08 12:21:37 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Em \&Smulx
|
2019-06-27 15:17:41 +00:00
|
|
|
Set a styled underscore.
|
|
|
|
The single parameter is one of: 0 for no underscore, 1 for normal
|
|
|
|
underscore, 2 for double underscore, 3 for curly underscore, 4 for dotted
|
|
|
|
underscore and 5 for dashed underscore.
|
|
|
|
The capability can typically be added to
|
|
|
|
.Ic terminal-overrides
|
|
|
|
as:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
Smulx=\eE[4::%p1%dm
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.It Em \&Setulc
|
|
|
|
Set the underscore colour.
|
|
|
|
The argument is (red * 65536) + (green * 256) + blue where each is between 0
|
|
|
|
and 255.
|
|
|
|
The capability can typically be added to
|
|
|
|
.Ic terminal-overrides
|
|
|
|
as:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
Setulc=\eE[58::2::%p1%{65536}%/%d::%p1%{256}%/%{255}%&%d::%p1%{255}%&%d%;m
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2013-06-02 14:40:17 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Em \&Ss , Se
|
2014-10-18 20:28:19 +00:00
|
|
|
Set or reset the cursor style.
|
2011-05-22 16:26:58 +00:00
|
|
|
If set, a sequence such as this may be used
|
|
|
|
to change the cursor to an underline:
|
2011-05-22 16:26:09 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ printf '\e033[4 q'
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
If
|
2014-10-18 20:28:19 +00:00
|
|
|
.Em Se
|
|
|
|
is not set, \&Ss with argument 0 will be used to reset the cursor style instead.
|
2016-01-29 11:13:56 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Em \&Tc
|
|
|
|
Indicate that the terminal supports the
|
|
|
|
.Ql direct colour
|
|
|
|
RGB escape sequence (for example, \ee[38;2;255;255;255m).
|
2017-01-07 15:40:23 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2018-10-11 15:20:14 +00:00
|
|
|
If supported, this is used for the initialize colour escape sequence (which
|
2017-01-07 15:40:23 +00:00
|
|
|
may be enabled by adding the
|
|
|
|
.Ql initc
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ql ccc
|
|
|
|
capabilities to the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
.Xr terminfo 5
|
|
|
|
entry).
|
2011-05-22 16:26:58 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Em \&Ms
|
2016-01-29 11:13:56 +00:00
|
|
|
Store the current buffer in the host terminal's selection (clipboard).
|
2011-05-22 16:26:58 +00:00
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Em set-clipboard
|
|
|
|
option above and the
|
|
|
|
.Xr xterm 1
|
|
|
|
man page.
|
2011-05-22 16:23:07 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh CONTROL MODE
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
offers a textual interface called
|
|
|
|
.Em control mode .
|
|
|
|
This allows applications to communicate with
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
using a simple text-only protocol.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
In control mode, a client sends
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
commands or command sequences terminated by newlines on standard input.
|
|
|
|
Each command will produce one block of output on standard output.
|
|
|
|
An output block consists of a
|
|
|
|
.Em %begin
|
|
|
|
line followed by the output (which may be empty).
|
|
|
|
The output block ends with a
|
|
|
|
.Em %end
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Em %error .
|
|
|
|
.Em %begin
|
|
|
|
and matching
|
|
|
|
.Em %end
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Em %error
|
|
|
|
have two arguments: an integer time (as seconds from epoch) and command number.
|
|
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
%begin 1363006971 2
|
|
|
|
0: ksh* (1 panes) [80x24] [layout b25f,80x24,0,0,2] @2 (active)
|
|
|
|
%end 1363006971 2
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2017-02-09 14:49:00 +00:00
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Ic refresh-client
|
|
|
|
.Fl C
|
|
|
|
command may be used to set the size of a client in control mode.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
In control mode,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
outputs notifications.
|
|
|
|
A notification will never occur inside an output block.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
The following notifications are defined:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width Ds
|
2017-05-04 07:16:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %client-session-changed Ar client Ar session-id Ar name
|
|
|
|
The client is now attached to the session with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar session-id ,
|
|
|
|
which is named
|
|
|
|
.Ar name .
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %exit Op Ar reason
|
|
|
|
The
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
client is exiting immediately, either because it is not attached to any session
|
|
|
|
or an error occurred.
|
|
|
|
If present,
|
|
|
|
.Ar reason
|
|
|
|
describes why the client exited.
|
2015-11-13 10:00:26 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %layout-change Ar window-id Ar window-layout Ar window-visible-layout Ar window-flags
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
The layout of a window with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
changed.
|
|
|
|
The new layout is
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-layout .
|
2015-11-13 10:00:26 +00:00
|
|
|
The window's visible layout is
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-visible-layout
|
|
|
|
and the window flags are
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-flags .
|
2013-03-11 15:28:34 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %output Ar pane-id Ar value
|
|
|
|
A window pane produced output.
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ar value
|
2013-03-12 22:48:58 +00:00
|
|
|
escapes non-printable characters and backslash as octal \\xxx.
|
2017-05-04 07:16:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %pane-mode-changed Ar pane-id
|
|
|
|
The pane with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar pane-id
|
|
|
|
has changed mode.
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %session-changed Ar session-id Ar name
|
|
|
|
The client is now attached to the session with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar session-id ,
|
|
|
|
which is named
|
|
|
|
.Ar name .
|
|
|
|
.It Ic %session-renamed Ar name
|
|
|
|
The current session was renamed to
|
|
|
|
.Ar name .
|
2017-05-04 07:16:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %session-window-changed Ar session-id Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
The session with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar session-id
|
|
|
|
changed its active window to the window with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-id .
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %sessions-changed
|
|
|
|
A session was created or destroyed.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic %unlinked-window-add Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
The window with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
was created but is not linked to the current session.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic %window-add Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
The window with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
was linked to the current session.
|
|
|
|
.It Ic %window-close Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
The window with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
closed.
|
2017-05-04 07:16:43 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %window-pane-changed Ar window-id Ar pane-id
|
|
|
|
The active pane in the window with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
changed to the pane with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar pane-id .
|
2013-03-11 13:06:30 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Ic %window-renamed Ar window-id Ar name
|
|
|
|
The window with ID
|
|
|
|
.Ar window-id
|
|
|
|
was renamed to
|
|
|
|
.Ar name .
|
|
|
|
.El
|
2019-05-07 14:01:39 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh ENVIRONMENT
|
|
|
|
When
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
is started, it inspects the following environment variables:
|
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width LC_CTYPE
|
|
|
|
.It Ev EDITOR
|
|
|
|
If the command specified in this variable contains the string
|
|
|
|
.Ql vi
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ev VISUAL
|
|
|
|
is unset, use vi-style key bindings.
|
|
|
|
Overridden by the
|
|
|
|
.Ic mode-keys
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-keys
|
|
|
|
options.
|
|
|
|
.It Ev HOME
|
|
|
|
The user's login directory.
|
|
|
|
If unset, the
|
|
|
|
.Xr passwd 5
|
|
|
|
database is consulted.
|
|
|
|
.It Ev LC_CTYPE
|
|
|
|
The character encoding
|
|
|
|
.Xr locale 1 .
|
|
|
|
It is used for two separate purposes.
|
|
|
|
For output to the terminal, UTF-8 is used if the
|
|
|
|
.Fl u
|
|
|
|
option is given or if
|
|
|
|
.Ev LC_CTYPE
|
|
|
|
contains
|
|
|
|
.Qq UTF-8
|
|
|
|
or
|
|
|
|
.Qq UTF8 .
|
|
|
|
Otherwise, only ASCII characters are written and non-ASCII characters
|
|
|
|
are replaced with underscores
|
|
|
|
.Pq Ql _ .
|
|
|
|
For input,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
always runs with a UTF-8 locale.
|
|
|
|
If en_US.UTF-8 is provided by the operating system it is used and
|
|
|
|
.Ev LC_CTYPE
|
|
|
|
is ignored for input.
|
|
|
|
Otherwise,
|
|
|
|
.Ev LC_CTYPE
|
|
|
|
tells
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
what the UTF-8 locale is called on the current system.
|
|
|
|
If the locale specified by
|
|
|
|
.Ev LC_CTYPE
|
|
|
|
is not available or is not a UTF-8 locale,
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
exits with an error message.
|
|
|
|
.It Ev LC_TIME
|
|
|
|
The date and time format
|
|
|
|
.Xr locale 1 .
|
|
|
|
It is used for locale-dependent
|
|
|
|
.Xr strftime 3
|
|
|
|
format specifiers.
|
|
|
|
.It Ev PWD
|
|
|
|
The current working directory to be set in the global environment.
|
|
|
|
This may be useful if it contains symbolic links.
|
|
|
|
If the value of the variable does not match the current working
|
|
|
|
directory, the variable is ignored and the result of
|
|
|
|
.Xr getcwd 3
|
|
|
|
is used instead.
|
|
|
|
.It Ev SHELL
|
|
|
|
The absolute path to the default shell for new windows.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Ic default-shell
|
|
|
|
option for details.
|
|
|
|
.It Ev TMUX_TMPDIR
|
|
|
|
The parent directory of the directory containing the server sockets.
|
|
|
|
See the
|
|
|
|
.Fl L
|
|
|
|
option for details.
|
|
|
|
.It Ev VISUAL
|
|
|
|
If the command specified in this variable contains the string
|
|
|
|
.Ql vi ,
|
|
|
|
use vi-style key bindings.
|
|
|
|
Overridden by the
|
|
|
|
.Ic mode-keys
|
|
|
|
and
|
|
|
|
.Ic status-keys
|
|
|
|
options.
|
|
|
|
.El
|
2008-06-16 17:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh FILES
|
2013-04-24 09:57:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.Bl -tag -width "@SYSCONFDIR@/tmux.confXXX" -compact
|
2008-06-16 17:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Pa ~/.tmux.conf
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
Default
|
2008-06-16 17:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.Nm
|
2009-06-25 15:30:29 +00:00
|
|
|
configuration file.
|
2013-04-24 09:57:03 +00:00
|
|
|
.It Pa @SYSCONFDIR@/tmux.conf
|
2009-07-14 06:38:14 +00:00
|
|
|
System-wide configuration file.
|
2008-06-16 17:35:40 +00:00
|
|
|
.El
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh EXAMPLES
|
|
|
|
To create a new
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
session running
|
|
|
|
.Xr vi 1 :
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Dl $ tmux new-session vi
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Most commands have a shorter form, known as an alias.
|
|
|
|
For new-session, this is
|
|
|
|
.Ic new :
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Dl $ tmux new vi
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Alternatively, the shortest unambiguous form of a command is accepted.
|
|
|
|
If there are several options, they are listed:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
$ tmux n
|
|
|
|
ambiguous command: n, could be: new-session, new-window, next-window
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Within an active session, a new window may be created by typing
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b c
|
|
|
|
(Ctrl
|
|
|
|
followed by the
|
|
|
|
.Ql b
|
|
|
|
key
|
|
|
|
followed by the
|
|
|
|
.Ql c
|
|
|
|
key).
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Windows may be navigated with:
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b 0
|
|
|
|
(to select window 0),
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b 1
|
|
|
|
(to select window 1), and so on;
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b n
|
|
|
|
to select the next window; and
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b p
|
|
|
|
to select the previous window.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
A session may be detached using
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b d
|
2009-08-09 17:55:59 +00:00
|
|
|
(or by an external event such as
|
|
|
|
.Xr ssh 1
|
|
|
|
disconnection) and reattached with:
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
.Dl $ tmux attach-session
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Typing
|
|
|
|
.Ql C-b \&?
|
|
|
|
lists the current key bindings in the current window; up and down may be used
|
|
|
|
to navigate the list or
|
|
|
|
.Ql q
|
|
|
|
to exit from it.
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Commands to be run when the
|
|
|
|
.Nm
|
|
|
|
server is started may be placed in the
|
|
|
|
.Pa ~/.tmux.conf
|
|
|
|
configuration file.
|
|
|
|
Common examples include:
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Changing the default prefix key:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
set-option -g prefix C-a
|
|
|
|
unbind-key C-b
|
|
|
|
bind-key C-a send-prefix
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Turning the status line off, or changing its colour:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
set-option -g status off
|
2014-01-28 23:07:09 +00:00
|
|
|
set-option -g status-style bg=blue
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Setting other options, such as the default command,
|
|
|
|
or locking after 30 minutes of inactivity:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
set-option -g default-command "exec /bin/ksh"
|
|
|
|
set-option -g lock-after-time 1800
|
|
|
|
.Ed
|
|
|
|
.Pp
|
|
|
|
Creating new key bindings:
|
|
|
|
.Bd -literal -offset indent
|
|
|
|
bind-key b set-option status
|
|
|
|
bind-key / command-prompt "split-window 'exec man %%'"
|
2009-08-20 11:51:20 +00:00
|
|
|
bind-key S command-prompt "new-window -n %1 'ssh %1'"
|
2009-08-06 19:25:44 +00:00
|
|
|
.Ed
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh SEE ALSO
|
2015-12-08 00:48:22 +00:00
|
|
|
.Xr pty 4
|
2007-11-09 15:23:28 +00:00
|
|
|
.Sh AUTHORS
|
2016-01-19 15:59:12 +00:00
|
|
|
.An Nicholas Marriott Aq Mt nicholas.marriott@gmail.com
|